blob: 279d07601f24ddf7b5ffef4b07eaf024600621ee [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucb928252015-12-20 23:33:18 +01007 2015/12/20
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200524 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200526 - description
527 - deviceatlas-json-file
528 - deviceatlas-log-level
529 - deviceatlas-separator
530 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900531 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532 - gid
533 - group
534 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200535 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100536 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200537 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100541 - presetenv
542 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - uid
544 - ulimit-n
545 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100546 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200547 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200548 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
549 - ssl-default-bind-options
550 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
551 - ssl-default-server-options
552 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100553 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100554 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100555 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100556 - 51degrees-data-file
557 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200558 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200559 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200562 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200564 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100565 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100566 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100567 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200568 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200569 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200570 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 - noepoll
573 - nokqueue
574 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100575 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300576 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200577 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200578 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200579 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200580 - tune.buffers.limit
581 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200582 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200583 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100584 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100585 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200586 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100587 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100588 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100589 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100590 - tune.lua.session-timeout
591 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200592 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100593 - tune.maxaccept
594 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200596 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200597 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100598 - tune.rcvbuf.client
599 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100600 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100601 - tune.sndbuf.client
602 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100603 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100604 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200605 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100606 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200607 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200608 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200609 - tune.vars.global-max-size
610 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
611 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
612 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100613 - tune.zlib.memlevel
614 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 * Debugging
617 - debug
618 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200619
620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006213.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622------------------------------------
623
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200624ca-base <dir>
625 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200626 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
627 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629chroot <jail dir>
630 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
631 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
632 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
633 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
634 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
635 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100636
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100637cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
638 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
639 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
640 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100641 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
642 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
643 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
644 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
645 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
646 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
647 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
648 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
649 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
650 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100651
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200652crt-base <dir>
653 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
654 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
655 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657daemon
658 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
659 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
660 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
661
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200662deviceatlas-json-file <path>
663 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
664 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
665
666deviceatlas-log-level <value>
667 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
668 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
669
670deviceatlas-separator <char>
671 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
672 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
673
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100674deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200675 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
676 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
677 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100678
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900679external-check
680 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
681 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
682 See "option external-check".
683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684gid <number>
685 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
686 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
687 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100688 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
689 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692group <group name>
693 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
694 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200696log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
698 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100699 configured with "log global".
700
701 <address> can be one of:
702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100703 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100704 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
705 port).
706
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100707 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100711 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
712 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
713 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
714 writeable).
715
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200716 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
717 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100718
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200719 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
720 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
721 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
722 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
723 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
724 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
725 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
726 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
727 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
728 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
729 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
730
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200731 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
732 one of the following :
733
734 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
735 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
736
737 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
738 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
739
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100740 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200741
742 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
743 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
744 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
745
746 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200747 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
748 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
749 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
750 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
751 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
752 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200754 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100756log-send-hostname [<string>]
757 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
758 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
759 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
760 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
761 the logs.
762
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000763log-tag <string>
764 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
765 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
766 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100767 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000768
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100769lua-load <file>
770 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
771 used multiple times.
772
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773nbproc <number>
774 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
775 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
776 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
777 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
778 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
779
780pidfile <pidfile>
781 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
782 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
783 starting the process. See also "daemon".
784
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100785presetenv <name> <value>
786 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
787 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
788 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
789 and "unsetenv".
790
791resetenv [<name> ...]
792 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
793 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
794 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
795 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
796 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
797 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
798 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
799 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
800
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100801stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200802 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
803 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
804 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
805 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
806 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
807 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100808 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200809 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
810 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200811
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200812server-state-base <directory>
813 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200814 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
815 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200816
817server-state-file <file>
818 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
819 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
820 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
821 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
822 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
823 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
824 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
825 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200826 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
827 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200828
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100829setenv <name> <value>
830 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
831 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
832 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
833 and "unsetenv".
834
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100835ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
837 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300838 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
840 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
841 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
842 "bind" keyword for more information.
843
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100844ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
846 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
847 keyword to see available options.
848
849 Example:
850 global
851 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
852
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100853ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
855 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300856 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
858 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
859 information.
860
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100861ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
863 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
864 keyword to see available options.
865
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200866ssl-dh-param-file <file>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
869 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
870 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
871 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200872 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
873 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
874 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
875 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200876 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
877 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
878 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
879
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100880ssl-server-verify [none|required]
881 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
882 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
883 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
884
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200885stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
886 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
887 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
888 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200889 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
890 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200891
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200892 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
893 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
894 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200895
896stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
897 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
898 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100899 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200900
901stats maxconn <connections>
902 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
903 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905uid <number>
906 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
907 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
908 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
909 one. See also "gid" and "user".
910
911ulimit-n <number>
912 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
913 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
914 option.
915
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100916unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
917 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
918
919 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
920 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
921 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
922 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
923 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
924 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
925 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
926 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
927 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
928 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
929
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100930unsetenv [<name> ...]
931 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
932 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
933 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
934 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
935 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
936 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
937 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200939user <user name>
940 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
941 See also "uid" and "group".
942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200943node <name>
944 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
945
946 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
947 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
948 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
949 traffic.
950
951description <text>
952 Add a text that describes the instance.
953
954 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
955 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
956 "<" and ">" characters.
957
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010095851degrees-data-file <file path>
959 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
960 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
961
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200962 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100963 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
964
96551degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
966 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
967 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
968 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
969
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200970 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100971 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
972
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100974 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
975 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
976
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200977 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
978 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
979
98051degrees-cache-size <number>
981 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
982 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
983 By default, this cache is disabled.
984
985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100986 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
987
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009893.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200990-----------------------
991
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200992max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
993 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
994 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
995 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
996 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
997 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
998 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
999 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1000 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1001
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002maxconn <number>
1003 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1004 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1005 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001006 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1007 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1008 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1009 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001010 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1011 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1012 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1013 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1014 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001016maxconnrate <number>
1017 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1018 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1019 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1020 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1021 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1022 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1023 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1024 fairness.
1025
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001026maxcomprate <number>
1027 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001028 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001029 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1030 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1031 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1032 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1033 default value.
1034
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001035maxcompcpuusage <number>
1036 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1037 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1038 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1039 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1040 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1041 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1042 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1043 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1044
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001045maxpipes <number>
1046 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1047 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1048 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1049 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1050 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1051 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1052
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001053maxsessrate <number>
1054 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1055 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1056 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1057 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1058 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1059 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1060 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1061 fairness.
1062
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001063maxsslconn <number>
1064 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1065 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1066 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1067 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1068 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1069 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1070 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001071 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1072 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1073 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1074 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1075 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1076 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1077 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001078
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001079maxsslrate <number>
1080 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1081 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1082 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1083 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1084 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1085 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1086 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1087 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1088 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1089 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1090
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001091maxzlibmem <number>
1092 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1093 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1094 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001095 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1096 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1097 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1098
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099noepoll
1100 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1101 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001102 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103
1104nokqueue
1105 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1106 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1107 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1108
1109nopoll
1110 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1111 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001112 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001113 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001115nosplice
1116 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1117 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1118 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001119 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001120 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1121 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1122 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1123 "option splice-response".
1124
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001125nogetaddrinfo
1126 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1127 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1128
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001129spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001130 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1131 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1132 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1133 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1134 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1135 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001136
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001137tune.buffers.limit <number>
1138 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1139 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1140 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1141 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1142 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1143 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1144 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1145 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1146 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1147 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1148 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1149 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1150 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1151 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1152 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1153
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001154tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1155 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1156 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1157 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1158 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1159
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001160tune.bufsize <number>
1161 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1162 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1163 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1164 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1165 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1166 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1167 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1168 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001169 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1170 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1171 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001172
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001173tune.chksize <number>
1174 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1175 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1176 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1177 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1178 checks whenever possible.
1179
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001180tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1181 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1182 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1183 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1184 this value. The default value is 1.
1185
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001186tune.http.cookielen <number>
1187 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1188 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1189 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1190 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1191 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1192 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1193 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1194 to change this value.
1195
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001196tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1197 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1198 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1199 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1200 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1201 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1202 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1203 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1204 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1205 limit too high.
1206
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001207tune.idletimer <timeout>
1208 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1209 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1210 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1211 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1212 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1213 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1214 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1215 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1216 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1217
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001218tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1219 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1220 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1221 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1222 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1223 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1224 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1225 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1226
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001227tune.lua.maxmem
1228 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1229 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1230 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1231 memory.
1232
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001233tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1234 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001235 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1236 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1237 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001238
1239tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1240 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1241 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1242 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1243 check servers.
1244
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001245tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1246 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1247 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1248 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1249 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1250
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001251tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001252 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1253 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1254 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1255 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1256 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1257 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1258 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1259 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1260 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1261 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001262
1263tune.maxpollevents <number>
1264 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1265 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1266 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1267 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1268 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1269
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001270tune.maxrewrite <number>
1271 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1272 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1273 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1274 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1275 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1276 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1277 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1278 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1279 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1280 bufsize.
1281
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001282tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1283 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1284 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1285 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1286 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1287 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1288 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1289 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1290 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1291 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1292 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1293 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1294 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1295 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1296 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1297 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1298 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1299 setting this parameter to 0.
1300
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001301tune.pipesize <number>
1302 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1303 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1304 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1305 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1306 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1307 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1308
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001309tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1310tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1311 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1312 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1313 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1314 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1315 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1316 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1317 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1318
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001319tune.recv_enough <number>
1320 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1321 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1322 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1323 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1324 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1325
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001326tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1327tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1328 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1329 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1330 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1331 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1332 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1333 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1334 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1335 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1336 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1337 notifying haproxy again.
1338
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001339tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001340 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1341 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1342 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001343 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1345 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1346 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1347 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1348 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001349 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1350 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001351
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001352tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1353 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1354 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1355 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1356 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1357 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1358 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1359
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001360tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1361 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001362 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001363 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1364 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1365 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1366 being used for too long.
1367
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001368tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1369 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1370 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1371 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1372 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1373 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1374 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1375 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1376 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1377 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1378 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001379 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1380 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001381
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001382tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1383 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1384 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1385 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1386 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1387 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1388 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1389 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001390 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1391 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001392
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001393tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1394 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1395 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1396 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1397 1000 entries.
1398
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001399tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1400tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1401tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1402tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1403 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1404 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1405 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1406 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1407 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1408
1409 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1410 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1411 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1412 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1413
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001414tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1415 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001416 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001417 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1418 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1419 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1420
1421tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1422 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1423 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1424 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1425 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014273.3. Debugging
1428--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429
1430debug
1431 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1432 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1433 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1434 system startup.
1435
1436quiet
1437 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1438 line argument "-q".
1439
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014413.4. Userlists
1442--------------
1443It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1444http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1445it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1446
1447userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001448 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001449 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1450
1451group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001452 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001453 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1454 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1455
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001456user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1457 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001458 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1459 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001460 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1461 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001462 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001463 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001464
1465
1466 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001467 userlist L1
1468 group G1 users tiger,scott
1469 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001471 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1472 user scott insecure-password elgato
1473 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001474
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001475 userlist L2
1476 group G1
1477 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001478
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001479 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1480 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1481 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001482
1483 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001484
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001485
14863.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001487----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001488It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1489several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1490instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1491values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1492automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1493In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1494using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1495tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1496reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1497Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1498that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1499each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001500
1501peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001502 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001503 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1504
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001505disabled
1506 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1507 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1508 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1509
1510enable
1511 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1512
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001513peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1514 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1515 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1516 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1517 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1518 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1519 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1520
1521 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1522 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1523
1524 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1525 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1526 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1527 across all peers.
1528
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001529 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1530 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001531
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001532 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001533 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001534 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1535 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1536 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001537
1538 backend mybackend
1539 mode tcp
1540 balance roundrobin
1541 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1542 stick on src
1543
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001544 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1545 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001546
1547
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015483.6. Mailers
1549------------
1550It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1551If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1552in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1553
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001554mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001555 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1556 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1557
1558mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1559 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1560
1561 Example:
1562 mailers mymailers
1563 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1564 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1565
1566 backend mybackend
1567 mode tcp
1568 balance roundrobin
1569
1570 email-alert mailers mymailers
1571 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1572 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1573
1574 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1575 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1576
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001577timeout mail <time>
1578 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1579 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1580 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1581 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1582
1583 Example:
1584 mailers mymailers
1585 timeout mail 20s
1586 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015884. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001589----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001591Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001592 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001593 - frontend <name>
1594 - backend <name>
1595 - listen <name>
1596
1597A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1598its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1599section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601
1602A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1603connections.
1604
1605A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1606to forward incoming connections.
1607
1608A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1609parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1612'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1613case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1614
1615Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1616logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1617proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1618However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1619name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1620
1621Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1622and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1625modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1626arbitrary criteria.
1627
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001628In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1629a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1630the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1631
1632 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1633 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1634 between responses and new requests.
1635
1636 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1637 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1638 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1639 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1640
1641 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1642 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1643 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1644
1645 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1646 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1647 client-facing connection remains open.
1648
1649 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1650 after the end of the response.
1651
1652The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1653frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1654following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1655weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1656
1657 Backend mode
1658
1659 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1660 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1661 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1662 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1663 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1664 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1665 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1666 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1667 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1668 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1669 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001671
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016734.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1674--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001676The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1677limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1678they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1679limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001680marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001681option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001682and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1683with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1684specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001686
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001687 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1688------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1689acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001690appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001691backlog X X X -
1692balance X - X X
1693bind - X X -
1694bind-process X X X X
1695block - X X X
1696capture cookie - X X -
1697capture request header - X X -
1698capture response header - X X -
1699clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001700compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1702cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001703declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001704default-server X - X X
1705default_backend X X X -
1706description - X X X
1707disabled X X X X
1708dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001709email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001710email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001711email-alert mailers X X X X
1712email-alert myhostname X X X X
1713email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714enabled X X X X
1715errorfile X X X X
1716errorloc X X X X
1717errorloc302 X X X X
1718-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1719errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001720force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001721fullconn X - X X
1722grace X X X X
1723hash-type X - X X
1724http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001725http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001726http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001727http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001728http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001729http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001730http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001731id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001732ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001733load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001734log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001735log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001736log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001737log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001738max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001739maxconn X X X -
1740mode X X X X
1741monitor fail - X X -
1742monitor-net X X X -
1743monitor-uri X X X -
1744option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1745option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1746option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1747option allbackups (*) X - X X
1748option checkcache (*) X - X X
1749option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1750option contstats (*) X X X -
1751option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1752option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1753option forceclose (*) X X X X
1754-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1755option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001756option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001757option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001758option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001759option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001760option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001761option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001762option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001763option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1764option httpchk X - X X
1765option httpclose (*) X X X X
1766option httplog X X X X
1767option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001768option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001769option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001770option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001771option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1772option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1773option logasap (*) X X X -
1774option mysql-check X - X X
1775option nolinger (*) X X X X
1776option originalto X X X X
1777option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001778option pgsql-check X - X X
1779option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001780option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001781option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782option smtpchk X - X X
1783option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1784option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1785option splice-request (*) X X X X
1786option splice-response (*) X X X X
1787option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1788option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1789-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001790option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1792option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1793option tcpka X X X X
1794option tcplog X X X X
1795option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001796external-check command X - X X
1797external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001798persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1799rate-limit sessions X X X -
1800redirect - X X X
1801redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1802redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1803reqadd - X X X
1804reqallow - X X X
1805reqdel - X X X
1806reqdeny - X X X
1807reqiallow - X X X
1808reqidel - X X X
1809reqideny - X X X
1810reqipass - X X X
1811reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001812reqitarpit - X X X
1813reqpass - X X X
1814reqrep - X X X
1815-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001816reqtarpit - X X X
1817retries X - X X
1818rspadd - X X X
1819rspdel - X X X
1820rspdeny - X X X
1821rspidel - X X X
1822rspideny - X X X
1823rspirep - X X X
1824rsprep - X X X
1825server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001826server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827source X - X X
1828srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001829stats admin - X X X
1830stats auth X X X X
1831stats enable X X X X
1832stats hide-version X X X X
1833stats http-request - X X X
1834stats realm X X X X
1835stats refresh X X X X
1836stats scope X X X X
1837stats show-desc X X X X
1838stats show-legends X X X X
1839stats show-node X X X X
1840stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001841-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1842stick match - - X X
1843stick on - - X X
1844stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001845stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001846stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001847tcp-check connect - - X X
1848tcp-check expect - - X X
1849tcp-check send - - X X
1850tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001851tcp-request connection - X X -
1852tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001853tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001854tcp-response content - - X X
1855tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001856timeout check X - X X
1857timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001858timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001859timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1860timeout connect X - X X
1861timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1862timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1863timeout http-request X X X X
1864timeout queue X - X X
1865timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001866timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001867timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1868timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001869timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001871unique-id-format X X X -
1872unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001874use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1876 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018794.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1880---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001881
1882This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1883
1884
1885acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1886 Declare or complete an access list.
1887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1888 no | yes | yes | yes
1889 Example:
1890 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1891 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1892 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001894 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001897appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1898 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1901 no | no | yes | yes
1902 Arguments :
1903 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1904 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1905
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001906 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 checked in each cookie value.
1908
1909 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1910 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1911 milliseconds.
1912
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001913 request-learn
1914 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1915 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1916 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1917 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1918 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1919 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1920
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001921 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1922 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1923 data following this prefix.
1924
1925 Example :
1926 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1927
1928 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1929 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1930
1931 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1932 2 modes are currently supported :
1933 - path-parameters :
1934 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1935 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1936 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1937 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1938 - query-string :
1939 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1940 query string.
1941
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001942 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1943 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1944 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001945
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001946 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1947 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948
1949
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001950backlog <conns>
1951 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 yes | yes | yes | no
1954 Arguments :
1955 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1956 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001957 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001958
1959 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1960 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1961 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1962 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1963 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1964 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1965 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1966 backlog parameter.
1967
1968 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1969 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1970 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1971
1972 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1973
1974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001976balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1979 yes | no | yes | yes
1980 Arguments :
1981 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1982 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1983 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1984 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1985
1986 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1987 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1988 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1989 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001990 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001991 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001992 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1993 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1994 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1995 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1996 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1997 it, so that you don't worry.
1998
1999 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2000 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2001 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2002 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2003 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2004 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2005 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2006 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002008 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2009 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2010 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2011 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2012 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2013 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2014 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2015 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2016
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002017 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002018 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002019 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2020 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002021 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002022 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2023 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2024 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2025 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2026 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002027 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2028 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2029 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2030 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2031 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2032 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2035 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2036 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2037 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2038 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2039 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2040 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2041 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002042 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002044 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2045 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2046 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002048 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2049 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2050 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2051 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2052 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2053 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2054 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2055 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2056 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2057 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2058 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2059 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002061 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002062 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2063 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2064 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2065 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2066 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2067 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2068 URIs start with a leading "/".
2069
2070 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2071 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2072 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2073 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002075 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002076 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2077
2078 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002079 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2080 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002081 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2082 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2083 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2084 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002085 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002086 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2087 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002088
2089 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2090 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2091 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2092 server will receive the request.
2093
2094 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2095 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2096 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2097 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2098 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002099 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2100 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2101 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002103 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2104 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2105 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2106 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2107 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002109 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002110 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2111 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2112 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2113
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002114 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2115 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2116 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2117
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002118 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002119 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002120 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2121 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2122 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2123 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2124 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2125 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002126 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002127 used instead.
2128
2129 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2130 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2131 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2132 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2133
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002134 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2135 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2136 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2137
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002138 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002141 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2142 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002143
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002144 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2145 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2146 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
2148 Examples :
2149 balance roundrobin
2150 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002151 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002152 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2153 balance hdr(host)
2154 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002155
2156 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2157 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002159 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002160 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2161 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2162 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2163 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2164
2165 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2166 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2167 defaults to 16 kB.
2168
2169 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2170 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2171
2172 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2173 Round Robin.
2174
2175 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2176 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2177 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2178 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2179
2180 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2181
2182 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002183 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002184 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2185 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2186 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002188 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189
2190
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002191bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2192bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2195 no | yes | yes | no
2196 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002197 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2198 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2199 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2200 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002201 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002202 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2203 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2204 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2205 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2206 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2207 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2208 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002209 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2210 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2211 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2212 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2213 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2214 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2215 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002216 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2217 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2218 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002219 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2220 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2221 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002222
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002223 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2224 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002225 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2226 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2227 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002228 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2229 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2230 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2231 the range.
2232
2233 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2234 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2235 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2236 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2237 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2238 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2239 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002240 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002241 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002243 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2244 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2245 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2246 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2247 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2248 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2249 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2250 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2251
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002252 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2253 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2254 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2255 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2258 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2259 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2260 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2261 in a frontend.
2262
2263 Example :
2264 listen http_proxy
2265 bind :80,:443
2266 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002267 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002269 listen http_https_proxy
2270 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002271 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002272
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002273 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2274 bind ipv6@:80
2275 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2276 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2277
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002278 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002279 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002280
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002281 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2282 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2283 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2284 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2285 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2286
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002287 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002288 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289
2290
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002291bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002292 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2294 yes | yes | yes | yes
2295 Arguments :
2296 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2297 may be used to override a default value.
2298
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002299 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002300 option may be combined with other numbers.
2301
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002302 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2304 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2305 missing from all processes.
2306
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002307 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002308 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002309 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2310 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2311 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2312 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002313
2314 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2315 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2316 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2317 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2318 and 'even' instances.
2319
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002320 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2321 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2322 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2323 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002324
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002325 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2326 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2327
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002328 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2329 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2330 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2331
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002332 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2333 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2334
2335 Example :
2336 listen app_ip1
2337 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002338 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002339
2340 listen app_ip2
2341 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002342 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002343
2344 listen management
2345 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002346 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002347
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002348 listen management
2349 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2350 bind-process 1-4
2351
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002352 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002353
2354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002355block { if | unless } <condition>
2356 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2358 no | yes | yes | yes
2359
2360 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2361 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002362 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002363 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2365 "block" statements per instance.
2366
2367 Example:
2368 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2369 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2370 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2371 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002373 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374
2375
2376capture cookie <name> len <length>
2377 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2379 no | yes | yes | no
2380 Arguments :
2381 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2382 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2383 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2384 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2385 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2386
2387 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2388 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2389 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2390 right if it exceeds <length>.
2391
2392 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2393 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2394 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2395 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2396
2397 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2398 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2399 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2400
2401 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2402 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2403 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002404 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2405 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2406 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
2408 Example:
2409 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2410
2411 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002412 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413
2414
2415capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002416 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2418 no | yes | yes | no
2419 Arguments :
2420 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002421 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2423 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2424 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2425
2426 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2427 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2428 it exceeds <length>.
2429
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002430 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2432 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002433 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2434 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2435 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2436 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002437 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002438 environments to find where the request came from.
2439
2440 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2441 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2442 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2443 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002445 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2446 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2447 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2448 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2449 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450
2451 Example:
2452 capture request header Host len 15
2453 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002454 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002456 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457 about logging.
2458
2459
2460capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002461 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 no | yes | yes | no
2464 Arguments :
2465 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002466 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2468 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2469 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2470
2471 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2472 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2473 it exceeds <length>.
2474
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002475 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2477 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2478 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002479 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2480 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2481 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2482 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002484 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2485 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2486 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2487 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2488 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
2490 Example:
2491 capture response header Content-length len 9
2492 capture response header Location len 15
2493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002494 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 about logging.
2496
2497
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002498clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 yes | yes | yes | no
2502 Arguments :
2503 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2504 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2505 as explained at the top of this document.
2506
2507 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2508 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2509 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2510 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2511 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2512 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2513 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2514 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002515 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2517 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2518
2519 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2520 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2521 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2522 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2523 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2524 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2525
2526 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2527 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2528
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002529 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2530 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002531
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002532compression algo <algorithm> ...
2533compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002534compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002535 Enable HTTP compression.
2536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2537 yes | yes | yes | yes
2538 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002539 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2540 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2541 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2542
2543 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002544 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2545 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2546 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002547
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002548 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002549 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002550
2551 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2552 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2553 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2554 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2555 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002556 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002557
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002558 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2559 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2560 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2561 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2562 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2563 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2564 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002565 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002566
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002567 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002568 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002569 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2570 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2571 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2572 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2573 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002574
2575 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2576 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2577 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2578 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2579 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002580 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2581 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2582 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2583 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2584 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002585 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2586 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002587
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002588 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002589 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2590 "Accept-Encoding" header
2591 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002592 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002593 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2594 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002595 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2596 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2597 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2598 "multipart"
2599 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2600 header
2601 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2602 and later
2603 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2604 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002605
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2607 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002608
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002609 Examples :
2610 compression algo gzip
2611 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002613contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 yes | no | yes | yes
2617 Arguments :
2618 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2619 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2620 as explained at the top of this document.
2621
2622 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002623 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002624 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002625 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2626 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2627 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2628 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2629
2630 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2631 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2632 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2633 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2634 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2635 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2636
2637 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2638 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2639 instead.
2640
2641 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2642 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2643
2644
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002645cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002646 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2647 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2650 yes | no | yes | yes
2651 Arguments :
2652 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2653 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2654 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2655 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2656 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2657 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2658 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2659 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2660 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2661
2662 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2663 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2664 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2665 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2666 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2667 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002668 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2669 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2670 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2671 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2672 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673
2674 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002675 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002676
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002677 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002678 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2679 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2680 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2681 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2682 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2683 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2684 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2685 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2686 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2687 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688
2689 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2690 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2691 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2692 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2693 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2694 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2695 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2696 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2697 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002698 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002699 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2700 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2701 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002703 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2704 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2705 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002706 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2707 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2708 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2709 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002710 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2711 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2712 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713
2714 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2715 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2716 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2717 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2718 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2719 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2720 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2721 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2722 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2723
2724 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2725 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2726 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2727 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2728 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2729 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2730 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2731 persistence cookie in the cache.
2732 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2733
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002734 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2735 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2736 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2737 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2738 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2739 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2740 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2741 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2742 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2743 they logout.
2744
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002745 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2746 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2747 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2748 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2749
2750 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2751 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2752 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2753 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2754 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2755 this attribute.
2756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002757 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002758 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002759 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2760 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2761 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2762 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2763 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2764 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002765
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002766 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2767 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2768 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2769 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2770 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2771 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2772 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2773 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2774 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2775 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2776 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2777 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2778 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2779 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2780 the site.
2781
2782 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2783 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2784 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2785 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2786 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2787 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2788 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2789 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2790 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2791 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2792 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2793 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2794 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2795 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2796 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2797 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2798
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2800 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2801 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2802 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804 Examples :
2805 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2806 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2807 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002808 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002810 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002812
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002813declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2814 Declares a capture slot.
2815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2816 no | yes | yes | no
2817 Arguments:
2818 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2819
2820 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2821 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2822 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2823 for use in the response.
2824
2825 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002826 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002827 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2828
2829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002830default-server [param*]
2831 Change default options for a server in a backend
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | no | yes | yes
2834 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002835 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2836 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2837 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2838 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002839
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002840 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002841 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2842
2843 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002845
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846default_backend <backend>
2847 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 yes | yes | yes | no
2850 Arguments :
2851 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2852
2853 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2854 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2855 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2856 will catch all undetermined requests.
2857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858 Example :
2859
2860 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2861 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2862 default_backend dynamic
2863
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002864 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002867description <string>
2868 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2870 no | yes | yes | yes
2871 Arguments : string
2872
2873 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2874 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2875 it describes.
2876 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2877
2878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879disabled
2880 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 yes | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : none
2884
2885 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2886 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2887 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2888 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2889 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2890 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2891 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2892
2893 See also : "enabled"
2894
2895
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002896dispatch <address>:<port>
2897 Set a default server address
2898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2899 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002901
2902 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2903 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2904 during start-up.
2905
2906 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2907 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2908 possible with normal servers.
2909
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002910 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002911 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2912 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2913 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2914 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2915
2916 See also : "server"
2917
2918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919enabled
2920 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2922 yes | yes | yes | yes
2923 Arguments : none
2924
2925 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2926 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2927
2928 See also : "disabled"
2929
2930
2931errorfile <code> <file>
2932 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments :
2936 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002937 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2938 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
2940 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002941 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002942 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002943 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2944 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002945
2946 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2947 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2948 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2949
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002950 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002952 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2953 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2954 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2955 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2956
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002957 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2958 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2959 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2960 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2961 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2962 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2965 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2966 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002967 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2969
2970 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2971
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002972 Example :
2973 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002974 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002975 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2976 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002978
2979errorloc <code> <url>
2980errorloc302 <code> <url>
2981 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | yes | yes | yes
2984 Arguments :
2985 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002986 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002987
2988 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2989 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2990 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2991 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2992 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2993
2994 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2995 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2996 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2997
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002998 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2999
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003000 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3001 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3002 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3003 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003004 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003005 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3006 request.
3007
3008 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3009
3010
3011errorloc303 <code> <url>
3012 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3014 yes | yes | yes | yes
3015 Arguments :
3016 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3017 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3018
3019 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3020 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3021 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3022 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3023 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3024
3025 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3026 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3027 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3028
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003029 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003031 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3032 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3033 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3034 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003035 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003036
3037 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3038
3039
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003040email-alert from <emailaddr>
3041 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3042 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3044 yes | yes | yes | yes
3045
3046 Arguments :
3047
3048 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3049
3050 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3051 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3052
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003053 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003054 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3055 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003056
3057
3058email-alert level <level>
3059 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3060 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 yes | yes | yes | yes
3063
3064 Arguments :
3065
3066 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3067 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3068 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3069
3070 By default level is alert
3071
3072 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3073 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3074 for the proxy.
3075
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003076 Alerts are sent when :
3077
3078 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3079 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3080 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3081 is notice or lower
3082 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3083 and a health check status update occurs
3084
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003085 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3086 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003087 section 3.6 about mailers.
3088
3089
3090email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3091 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 yes | yes | yes | yes
3094
3095 Arguments :
3096
3097 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3098
3099 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3100 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3101
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003102 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3103 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003104
3105
3106email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3107 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3108 mailers.
3109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 yes | yes | yes | yes
3111
3112 Arguments :
3113
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003114 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003115
3116 By default the systems hostname is used.
3117
3118 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3119 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3120 for the proxy.
3121
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003122 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3123 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003124
3125
3126email-alert to <emailaddr>
3127 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3128 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3129 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3130 yes | yes | yes | yes
3131
3132 Arguments :
3133
3134 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3135
3136 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3137 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3138
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003139 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003140 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3141
3142
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003143force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3144 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 no | yes | yes | yes
3147
3148 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3149 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3150 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3151 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3152 marked down for maintenance operations.
3153
3154 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3155 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3156 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3157 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3158 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3159 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3160 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3161 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3162 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3163
3164 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3165 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3166 is used.
3167
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003168 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003169 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003170
3171
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003172fullconn <conns>
3173 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | no | yes | yes
3176 Arguments :
3177 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3178 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3179
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003180 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003181 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003182 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003183 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3184 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3185 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3186 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3187 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003188 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003189
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003190 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3191 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003192 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3193 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3194 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003196 Example :
3197 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3198 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3199 # connections.
3200 backend dynamic
3201 fullconn 10000
3202 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3203 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3204
3205 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3206
3207
3208grace <time>
3209 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003211 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003212 Arguments :
3213 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3214 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3215 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3216
3217 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3218 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003219 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003220 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3221
3222 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3223 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3224 simplify it.
3225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003226
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003227hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003228 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3230 yes | no | yes | yes
3231 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003232 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3233 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003234
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003235 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3236 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3237 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3238 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3239 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3240 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3241 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3242 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3243 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3244 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003245
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003246 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3247 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3248 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3249 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3250 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3251 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3252 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3253 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3254 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3255 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3256 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3257 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3258 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003259 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3260 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003261
3262 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3263
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003264 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003265 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3266 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3267 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003268 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3269 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3270 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003271
3272 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3273 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003274 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3275 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3276 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3277 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3278
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003279 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3280 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3281 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3282 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3283 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3284 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3285 parameter.
3286
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003287 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3288 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3289 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3290 used on strings.
3291
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003292 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3293
3294 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3295 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3296 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3297 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3298 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3299 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3300 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3301 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3302 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3303 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3304 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3305 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003306
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003307 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3308 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3309 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003310
3311 See also : "balance", "server"
3312
3313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314http-check disable-on-404
3315 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003317 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003318 Arguments : none
3319
3320 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3321 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3322 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3323 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3324 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3325 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3326 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3327 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003328 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3329 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3330 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3331
3332 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3333
3334
3335http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003336 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003338 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003339 Arguments :
3340 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3341 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003342 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003343 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3344 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3345 details on the supported keywords.
3346
3347 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3348 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3349 with the usual backslash ('\').
3350
3351 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3352 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3353 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3354 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3355 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3356
3357 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003358 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003359 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3360 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3361 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3362
3363 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003364 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003365 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3366 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3367 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3368 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3369
3370 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003371 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003372 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3373 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3374 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3375 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3376 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3377 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3378 trace).
3379
3380 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003381 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003382 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3383 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3384 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3385 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3386 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3387 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3388
3389 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3390 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3391 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3392 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3393 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3394 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3395 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3396 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3397
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003398 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3399 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3400 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3401
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003402 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3403 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3404
3405 Examples :
3406 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003407 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003408
3409 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003410 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003411
3412 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003413 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003414
3415 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003416 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003417
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003418 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003419
3420
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003421http-check send-state
3422 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3424 yes | no | yes | yes
3425 Arguments : none
3426
3427 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3428 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3429 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3430 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3431 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3432
3433 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3434 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3435 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3436 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3437 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003438 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3439 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3440 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3441
3442 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3443 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3444 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3445
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003446 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3447 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3448 checked in multiple backends.
3449
3450 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3451 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3452
3453 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3454 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3455 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3456 one fails.
3457
3458 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3459 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3460 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3461
3462 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3463 server's queue.
3464
3465 Example of a header received by the application server :
3466 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3467 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3468
3469 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3470
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003471http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003472 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003473 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003474 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003475 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3476 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003477 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3478 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003479 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3480 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3481 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003482 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003483 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003484 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003485 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003486 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003487 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003488 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003489 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003490 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3491
3492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 no | yes | yes | yes
3494
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003495 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3496 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3497 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3498 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3499 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003500
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003501 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3502 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3503 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3504
3505 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3506 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3507 are evaluated.
3508
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003509 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3510 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3511 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3512 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3513 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3514 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3515 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3516 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3517 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003518 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003519 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3520 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003521
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003522 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3523 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3524 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3525 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3526 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3527
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003528 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3529 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3530 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003531 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3532 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003533
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003534 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3535 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3536 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3537 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3538 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3539 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3540 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3541 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3542
3543 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3544 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3545 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003546 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3547 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003548
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003549 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3550 <name>.
3551
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003552 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3553 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3554 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3555 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3556 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3557 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3558 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3559 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3560
3561 Example:
3562
3563 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3564
3565 applied to:
3566
3567 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3568
3569 outputs:
3570
3571 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3572
3573 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3574
3575 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3576 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3577 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3578 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3579 header.
3580
3581 Example:
3582
3583 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3584
3585 applied to:
3586
3587 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3588
3589 outputs:
3590
3591 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3592
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003593 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3594 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3595 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3596 it.
3597
3598 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3599 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3600 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3601 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3602 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3603 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3604
3605 Example :
3606 # prepend the host name before the path
3607 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3608
3609 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3610 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3611 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3612 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3613 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3614 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3615 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3616 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3617
3618 Example :
3619 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3620 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3621
3622 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3623 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3624 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3625 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3626 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3627 "set-query".
3628
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003629 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3630 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3631 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3632 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3633 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3634 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3635 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3636 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3637
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003638 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3639 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3640 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3641 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3642 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3643 another equipment.
3644
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003645 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3646 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3647 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3648 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3649 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3650 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3651 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3652 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3653
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003654 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3655 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3656 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3657 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3658 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3659 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3660 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3661 admin privileges.
3662
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003663 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3664 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3665 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3666 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3667 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3668 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3669 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3670 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3671
3672 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3673 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3674 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3675 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3676 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3677 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3678
3679 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3680 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3681 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3682 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3683 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3684 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3685
3686 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3687 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3688 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3689 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3690 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3691 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3692 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3693 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3694 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3695
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003696 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003697 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3698 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3699 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3700 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3701 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3702 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3703 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3704 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3705 request header" for more information.
3706
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003707 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3708 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3709 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3710 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003711 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3712 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003713
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003714 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3715 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3716 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3717 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3718 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3719 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3720 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3721 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3722 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3723 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3724 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3725 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3726
3727 These actions take one or two arguments :
3728 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3729 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3730 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3731 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3732
3733 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3734 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3735 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3736 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3737
3738 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3739 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3740 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3741 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3742 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3743 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3744 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3745 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3746
3747 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3748 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3749 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3750 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3751 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3752
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003753 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3754 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3755 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3756 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3757 continues.
3758
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003759 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3760 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3761 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3762 the actions evaluation continues.
3763
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003764 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3765 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3766 inline.
3767
3768 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3769 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3770 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3771 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3772 (request and response)
3773 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3774 processing
3775 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3776 processing.
3777 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3778 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3779 and '_'.
3780
3781 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3782 followed by some converters.
3783
3784 Example:
3785
3786 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3787
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003788 - set-src <expr> :
3789 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3790 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3791 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3792 source IP for privacy.
3793
3794 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3795 followed by some converters.
3796
3797 Example:
3798
3799 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3800 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3801
3802 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3803
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003804 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3805 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3806 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3807 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3808 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3809 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3810 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3811 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3812 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3813 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3814 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3815 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3816 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3817 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3818 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3819 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3820
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003821 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3822
3823 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3824 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003825 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3826 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3827
3828 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3829 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3830 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3831 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003832
3833 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003834 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3835 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3836 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003837
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003838 http-request allow if nagios
3839 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3840 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3841 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003842
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003843 Example:
3844 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003845 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003846
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003847 Example:
3848 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3849 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003850 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003851 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3852 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3853 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3854 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3855 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3856 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3857
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003858 Example:
3859 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3860 acl add path /addacl
3861 acl del path /delacl
3862
3863 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3864
3865 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3866 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3867
3868 Example:
3869 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3870 acl setmap path /setmap
3871 acl delmap path /delmap
3872
3873 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3874
3875 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3876 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3877
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003878 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3879 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003880
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003881http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003882 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003883 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003884 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3885 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003886 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003887 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3888 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3889 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3890 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003891 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003892 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003893 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003894 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003895 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003896 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003898 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3899
3900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3901 no | yes | yes | yes
3902
3903 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3904 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3905 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3906 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3907 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3908 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3909
3910 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3911 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3912 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3913 current section.
3914
3915 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3916 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3917 rules are evaluated.
3918
3919 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3920 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3921 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3922 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3923 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3924 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3925 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3926
3927 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3928 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3929 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3930 external users.
3931
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003932 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3933 <name>.
3934
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003935 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3936 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3937 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3938 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3939 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3940 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3941 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3942 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3943
3944 Example:
3945
3946 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3947
3948 applied to:
3949
3950 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3951
3952 outputs:
3953
3954 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3955
3956 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3957
3958 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3959 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3960 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3961 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3962 header.
3963
3964 Example:
3965
3966 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3967
3968 applied to:
3969
3970 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3971
3972 outputs:
3973
3974 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3975
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003976 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
3977 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
3978 adapted to the new code.
3979
3980 Example:
3981
3982 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
3983 http-response set-status 431
3984
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003985 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3986 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3987 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3988 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3989 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3990 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3991 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3992 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3993
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003994 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3995 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3996 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3997 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3998 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3999 another equipment.
4000
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004001 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4002 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4003 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4004 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4005 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4006 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4007 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4008 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4009
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004010 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4011 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4012 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4013 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4014 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4015 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4016 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4017 admin privileges.
4018
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004019 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4020 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4021 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4022 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4023 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4024 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4025 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4026 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4027
4028 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4029 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4030 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4031 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4032 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4033 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4034
4035 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4036 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4037 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4038 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4039 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4040 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4041
4042 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4043 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4044 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4045 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4046 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4047 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4048 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4049 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4050 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4051
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004052 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4053 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4054 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4055 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4056 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4057 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4058 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4059 response header" for more information.
4060
4061 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4062 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4063 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4064 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4065 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004066 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4067 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004068
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004069 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4070 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4071 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4072 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4073 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4074 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4075
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004076 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4077 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4078 inline.
4079
4080 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
4081 scope. The allowed scopes are:
4082 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
4083 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
4084 (request and response)
4085 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
4086 processing
4087 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
4088 processing.
4089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4090 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4091 and '_'.
4092
4093 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4094 followed by some converters.
4095
4096 Example:
4097
4098 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4099
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004100 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4101 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4102 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4103 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4104 continues.
4105
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004106 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4107 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4108 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4109 the actions evaluation continues.
4110
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004111 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4112 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4113 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4114 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4115 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4116 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4117 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4118 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4119 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4120 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4121 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4122 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4123 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4124 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4125 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4126 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4127
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004128 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4129
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004130 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004131 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4132 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004133 rules.
4134
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004135 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4136 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4137 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4138 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4139
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004140 Example:
4141 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4142
4143 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4144
4145 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4146 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4147
4148 Example:
4149 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4150
4151 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4152
4153 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4154 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4155
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004156 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4157 ACL usage.
4158
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004159
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004160http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4161 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4162
4163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4164 yes | no | yes | yes
4165
4166 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4167 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4168 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4169 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4170 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4171 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4172
4173 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4174
4175 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4176 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4177 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4178 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4179 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4180 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4181 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4182 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4183 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4184 not checking any request past the first one.
4185
4186 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4187 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4188 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4189 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4190 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4191 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4192 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4193
4194 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4195 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4196 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4197 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4198 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4199 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4200 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4201 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4202 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4203 downsides of rare connection failures.
4204
4205 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4206 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4207 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4208 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4209 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4210 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4211 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4212 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4213 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4214 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4215 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4216 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4217
4218 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4219 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4220 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4221 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4222
4223 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4224 and are never shared ;
4225
4226 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4227 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4228 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4229 and are never shared ;
4230
4231 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4232 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4233 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4234
4235 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4236 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4237 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4238
4239 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4240
4241
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004242http-send-name-header [<header>]
4243 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4244
4245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 yes | no | yes | yes
4247
4248 Arguments :
4249
4250 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4251
4252 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4253 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4254 is added with the header string proved.
4255
4256 See also : "server"
4257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004258id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004259 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4261 no | yes | yes | yes
4262 Arguments : none
4263
4264 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4265 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4266 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004267
4268
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004269ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4270 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 no | yes | yes | yes
4273
4274 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4275 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4276 and running).
4277
4278 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4279 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4280 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004281 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004282 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4283
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004284 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4285 "unless" condition is met.
4286
4287 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4288
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004289load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4290 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4292 yes | no | yes | yes
4293
4294 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4295 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4296 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4297 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4298 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4299 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4300 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4301 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4302
4303 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4304 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004305 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004306
4307 Arguments:
4308 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4309 named "server-state-file".
4310
4311 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4312 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4313 name is used as a file name.
4314
4315 none don't load any stat for this backend
4316
4317 Notes:
4318 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4319 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4320 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4321
4322 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4323 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4324
4325 Example 1:
4326
4327 Minimal configuration:
4328
4329 global
4330 stats socket /tmp/socket
4331 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4332
4333 defaults
4334 load-server-state-from-file global
4335
4336 backend bk
4337 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4338 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4339
4340 Then one can run :
4341
4342 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4343
4344 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4345
4346 1
4347 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4348 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4349 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4350
4351 Example 2:
4352
4353 Minimal configuration:
4354
4355 global
4356 stats socket /tmp/socket
4357 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4358
4359 defaults
4360 load-server-state-from-file local
4361
4362 backend bk
4363 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4364 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4365
4366 Then one can run :
4367
4368 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4369
4370 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4371
4372 1
4373 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4374 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4375 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4376
4377 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4378 "show servers state"
4379
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004381log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004382log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004383no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004384 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004387
4388 Prefix :
4389 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4390 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4391 prefix does not allow arguments.
4392
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004393 Arguments :
4394 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4395 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4396 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4397 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4398 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4399 parameter.
4400
4401 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4402 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4403
4404 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4405 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4406 standard syslog port).
4407
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004408 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4409 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4410 standard syslog port).
4411
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004412 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4413 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4414 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4415 appropriately writeable).
4416
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004417 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4418 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004419
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004420 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4421 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4422 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4423 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4424 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4425 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4426 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4427 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4428 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4429 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4430 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004432 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4433
4434 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4435 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4436 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4437
4438 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4439 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4440 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004441 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4442 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4443 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4444 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4445 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
4447 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4448
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004449 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4450 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4451 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004452
4453 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4454 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4455 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4456 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4457
4458 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4459 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004460
4461 Example :
4462 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004463 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4464 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004465 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004466
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004467
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004468log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004469 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4471 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004472
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004473 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4474 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4475 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4476 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4477 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004478
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004479log-format-sd <string>
4480 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4482 yes | yes | yes | no
4483
4484 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4485 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4486 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4487 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4488 which covers the log format string in depth.
4489
4490 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4491 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4492
4493 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4494 log format to "rfc5424".
4495
4496 Example :
4497 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4498
4499
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004500log-tag <string>
4501 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | yes | yes | yes
4504
4505 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4506 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4507 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4508 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4509 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4510 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4511 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4512 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4513 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004514
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004515max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4516 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4517 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4518 yes | no | yes | yes
4519
4520 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4521 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4522 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4523 servers.
4524
4525 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4526 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4527 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4528 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4529 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4530 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4531 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4532 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4533 picking a different server.
4534
4535 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4536 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4537 even if they have to be queued.
4538
4539 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4540 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4541
4542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004543maxconn <conns>
4544 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4546 yes | yes | yes | no
4547 Arguments :
4548 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4549 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4550 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4551 closes.
4552
4553 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4554 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4555 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4556 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4557 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4558 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4559 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4560 properly tuned.
4561
4562 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4563 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4564 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4565
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004566 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004568 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4569
4570
4571mode { tcp|http|health }
4572 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4574 yes | yes | yes | yes
4575 Arguments :
4576 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4577 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4578 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4579 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4580
4581 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4582 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4583 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4584 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4585 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4586
4587 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004588 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4589 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4590 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4591 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4592 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4593 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4594 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004595
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004596 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4597 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4598 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004599
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004600 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004601 defaults http_instances
4602 mode http
4603
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004604 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004607monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004608 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611 Arguments :
4612 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4613 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004614 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4616 backend and its backup.
4617
4618 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4619 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4620 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4621 servers in a list of backends.
4622
4623 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4624 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4625 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4626 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4627 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4628 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4629 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004630 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4631 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004632
4633 Example:
4634 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004635 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004636 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4637 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4638 monitor-uri /site_alive
4639 monitor fail if site_dead
4640
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004641 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004642
4643
4644monitor-net <source>
4645 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 yes | yes | yes | no
4648 Arguments :
4649 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4650 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4651 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4652 followed by a mask.
4653
4654 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4655 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004656 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004657 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4658
4659 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4660 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4661 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4662 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004663 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4664 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4665 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004666
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004667 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4668 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4669 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4670 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4671 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4672 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004673
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004674 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4675 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004677 Example :
4678 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4679 frontend www
4680 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4681
4682 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4683
4684
4685monitor-uri <uri>
4686 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 yes | yes | yes | no
4689 Arguments :
4690 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4691 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4692
4693 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4694 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4695 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4696 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4697 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4698 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4699 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4700 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4701
4702 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4703 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4704 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4705 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4706 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4707 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4708
4709 Example :
4710 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4711 frontend www
4712 mode http
4713 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4714
4715 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004718option abortonclose
4719no option abortonclose
4720 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 yes | no | yes | yes
4723 Arguments : none
4724
4725 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4726 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4727 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4728 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004729 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004730 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4731 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4732 encountered while delivering the response.
4733
4734 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4735 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4736 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4737 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4738 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4739 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004740 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004741 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004742 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004743 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4744 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4745 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4746
4747 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4748 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4749 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4750 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4751 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4752 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4753 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4754 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004755 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004756
4757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4759
4760 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4761
4762
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004763option accept-invalid-http-request
4764no option accept-invalid-http-request
4765 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4767 yes | yes | yes | no
4768 Arguments : none
4769
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004770 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004771 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4772 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4773 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4774 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4775 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4776 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4777 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004778 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4779 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4780 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4781 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4782 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004783 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004784 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4785 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4786 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004787
4788 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4789 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4790 been confirmed.
4791
4792 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4793 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004794 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4795 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004796 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4797
4798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4800
4801 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4802 stats socket.
4803
4804
4805option accept-invalid-http-response
4806no option accept-invalid-http-response
4807 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | no | yes | yes
4810 Arguments : none
4811
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004812 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004813 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4814 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4815 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4816 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4817 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4818 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4819 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004820 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4821 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4822 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004823
4824 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4825 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4826 been confirmed.
4827
4828 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4829 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4830 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4831 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4832
4833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4835
4836 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4837 stats socket.
4838
4839
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004840option allbackups
4841no option allbackups
4842 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4844 yes | no | yes | yes
4845 Arguments : none
4846
4847 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4848 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4849 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4850 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4851 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4852 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4853 order between the backup servers anymore.
4854
4855 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4856 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4857
4858 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4859 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4860
4861
4862option checkcache
4863no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004864 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | no | yes | yes
4867 Arguments : none
4868
4869 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4870 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004871 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004872 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4873 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004874 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004875
4876 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004877 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004878 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004879 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4880 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004881 to the client are :
4882 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004883 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004884 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004885 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4886 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4887 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4888 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4889 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4890 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4891 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4892 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4893 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4894 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4895 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4896
4897 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004898 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004899 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004900 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004901 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4902
4903 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4904 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004905 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004906 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4907
4908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4910
4911
4912option clitcpka
4913no option clitcpka
4914 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4916 yes | yes | yes | no
4917 Arguments : none
4918
4919 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4920 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4921 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4922 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4923
4924 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4925 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4926 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4927 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4928
4929 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4930 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4931 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4932 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4933 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4934
4935 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4936
4937 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4938 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4939 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4940
4941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4943
4944 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4945
4946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004947option contstats
4948 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4950 yes | yes | yes | no
4951 Arguments : none
4952
4953 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4954 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4955 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4956 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4957 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4958 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4959 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4960
4961
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004962option dontlog-normal
4963no option dontlog-normal
4964 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | yes | yes | no
4967 Arguments : none
4968
4969 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4970 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4971 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4972 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4973 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4974 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4975 logged.
4976
4977 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4978 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4979 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004981 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004982 logging.
4983
4984
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004985option dontlognull
4986no option dontlognull
4987 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4989 yes | yes | yes | no
4990 Arguments : none
4991
4992 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4993 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4994 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4995 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4996 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4997 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004998 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4999 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5000 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005001
5002 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5003 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5004 would not be logged.
5005
5006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5008
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005009 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5010 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005011
5012
5013option forceclose
5014no option forceclose
5015 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005018 Arguments : none
5019
5020 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5021 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5022 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5023 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5024 global session times in the logs.
5025
5026 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005027 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005028 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005029
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005030 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5031 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5032 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5033
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005034 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5035 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005036
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5039
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005040 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005041
5042
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005043option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005044 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5046 yes | yes | yes | yes
5047 Arguments :
5048 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5049 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005050 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005051 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005052
5053 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5054 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5055 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5056 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5057 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5058 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5059 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005060 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5061 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5062 possible that the client has already brought one.
5063
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005064 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005065 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005066 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5067 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005068 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5069 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005070
5071 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5072 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5073 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5074 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5075 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5076 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5077 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5078
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005079 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5080 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5081 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5082 are under the control of the end-user.
5083
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005084 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005085 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5086 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005087 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5088 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5089 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005090
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005091 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005092 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5093 frontend www
5094 mode http
5095 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5096
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005097 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5098 backend www
5099 mode http
5100 option forwardfor header X-Client
5101
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005102 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005103 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005104
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005105
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005106option http-buffer-request
5107no option http-buffer-request
5108 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5110 yes | yes | yes | yes
5111 Arguments : none
5112
5113 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5114 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5115 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5116 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5117 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5118 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5119 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5120 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5121 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5122 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5123 default.
5124
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005125 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005126
5127
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005128option http-ignore-probes
5129no option http-ignore-probes
5130 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 yes | yes | yes | no
5133 Arguments : none
5134
5135 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5136 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5137 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5138 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5139 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5140 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5141 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5142 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5143 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5144 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5145 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5146 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5147
5148 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5149 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5150 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5151 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5152 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5153 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5154 are often the only way to detect them.
5155
5156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5158
5159 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5160
5161
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005162option http-keep-alive
5163no option http-keep-alive
5164 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5166 yes | yes | yes | yes
5167 Arguments : none
5168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005169 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5170 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5171 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5172 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5173 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5174 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5175 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5176
5177 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5178 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005179 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5180 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5181 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5182 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5183 situations where this option may be useful :
5184
5185 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5186 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5187
5188 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5189 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5190
5191 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5192 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5193 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5194 request.
5195
5196 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5197 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005198 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5199 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5200 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005201
5202 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5203 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5204
5205 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5206 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5207 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5208 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5209 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5210 not set.
5211
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005212 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5213 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005214 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005215 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005216
5217 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005218 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5219 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005220
5221
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005222option http-no-delay
5223no option http-no-delay
5224 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | yes | yes | yes
5227 Arguments : none
5228
5229 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5230 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5231 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5232 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5233 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5234 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5235 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5236 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5237 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5238 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5239 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5240 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5241 affected.
5242
5243 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5244 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5245 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5246 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5247 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5248 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5249 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5250 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5251 latency environments.
5252
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005253 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5254
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005255
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005256option http-pretend-keepalive
5257no option http-pretend-keepalive
5258 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 yes | yes | yes | yes
5261 Arguments : none
5262
5263 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5264 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5265 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5266 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5267 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5268 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5269 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5270 consider the response complete.
5271
5272 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5273 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5274 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5275 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5276 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5277 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5278
5279 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5280 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5281 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5282 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5283 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5284 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5285 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5286
5287 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5288 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005289 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005290 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5291 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005292
5293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5295
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005296 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5297 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005298
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005299
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005300option http-server-close
5301no option http-server-close
5302 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | yes | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005307 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5308 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5309 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5310 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5311 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5312 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5313 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5314 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5315 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5316 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5317 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5318 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5319 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5320 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5321 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5322 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005323
5324 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5325 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5326 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5327 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005328 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5329 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005330
5331 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5332 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005333 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5334 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005335 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5336 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005337
5338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5340
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005341 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005342 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5343 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005344
5345
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005346option http-tunnel
5347no option http-tunnel
5348 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5350 yes | yes | yes | yes
5351 Arguments : none
5352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005353 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5354 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5355 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5356 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5357 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5358 "option http-tunnel".
5359
5360 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005361 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005362 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5363 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5364 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5365 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5366 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5367 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5368 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005369
5370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5372
5373 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5374 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5375 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5376
5377
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005378option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005379no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005380 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | no
5383 Arguments : none
5384
5385 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5386 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5387 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5388 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5389 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5390 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5391 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5392
5393 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5394 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005395 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5396 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5397 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005398
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005399 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5400 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5401 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5402 front of an existing proxy.
5403
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005404 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5405
5406 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5407 http-server-close".
5408
5409
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005410option httpchk
5411option httpchk <uri>
5412option httpchk <method> <uri>
5413option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5414 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 yes | no | yes | yes
5417 Arguments :
5418 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5419 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5420 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5421 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5422 ones.
5423
5424 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5425 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5426 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5427
5428 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5429 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5430 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5431 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5432 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5433
5434 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5435 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5436 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5437 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5438 the lack of any response.
5439
5440 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5441
5442 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5443 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5444 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5445
5446 Examples :
5447 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5448 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5449 backend https_relay
5450 mode tcp
5451 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5452 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5453
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005454 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5455 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5456 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005457
5458
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005459option httpclose
5460no option httpclose
5461 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 yes | yes | yes | yes
5464 Arguments : none
5465
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005466 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5467 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5468 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5469 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005470 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005471 "option http-tunnel".
5472
5473 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5474 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5475 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5476 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5477 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5478 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5479 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5480 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005481
5482 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005483 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005484 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5485 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5486 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5487 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5488 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005489
5490 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5491 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005492 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5493 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005494 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5495 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005496
5497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5499
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005500 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5501 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005502
5503
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005504option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005505 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5507 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005508 Arguments :
5509 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5510 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5511 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5512 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5513 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005514
5515 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5516 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5517 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5518 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5519 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5520 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5521 ports.
5522
5523 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5524
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005525 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5526 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005528 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005529
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005530
5531option http_proxy
5532no option http_proxy
5533 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5535 yes | yes | yes | yes
5536 Arguments : none
5537
5538 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5539 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5540 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5541 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5542 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5543
5544 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5545 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005546 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5547 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005548
5549 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5550 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5551
5552 Example :
5553 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5554 backend direct_forward
5555 option httpclose
5556 option http_proxy
5557
5558 See also : "option httpclose"
5559
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005560
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005561option independent-streams
5562no option independent-streams
5563 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | yes | yes | yes
5566 Arguments : none
5567
5568 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5569 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5570 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5571 receive data or not.
5572
5573 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5574 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5575 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5576 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5577 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5578 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5579 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5580 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5581 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5582 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5583 socket buffers.
5584
5585 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5586 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5587 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5588 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5589 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5590
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005591 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005592 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5593 deprecated.
5594
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005595 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005596
5597
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005598option ldap-check
5599 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5601 yes | no | yes | yes
5602 Arguments : none
5603
5604 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5605 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5606 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5607 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5608
5609 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5610 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5611
5612 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5613 configure it.
5614
5615 Example :
5616 option ldap-check
5617
5618 See also : "option httpchk"
5619
5620
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005621option external-check
5622 Use external processes for server health checks
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625
5626 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5627 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5628 command".
5629
5630 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5631
5632 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5633
5634
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005635option log-health-checks
5636no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005637 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5639 yes | no | yes | yes
5640 Arguments : none
5641
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005642 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5643 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5644 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005645
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005646 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5647 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5648 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5649 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5650 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5651
5652 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5653 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005654
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005655 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5656 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5657 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005658
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005659
5660option log-separate-errors
5661no option log-separate-errors
5662 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 yes | yes | yes | no
5665 Arguments : none
5666
5667 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5668 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5669 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5670 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5671 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5672 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5673 provides very important information.
5674
5675 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5676 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5677 error logs.
5678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005679 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005680 logging.
5681
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005682
5683option logasap
5684no option logasap
5685 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 yes | yes | yes | no
5688 Arguments : none
5689
5690 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5691 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5692 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5693 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5694 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5695 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5696 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005697 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005698 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5699 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005701 Examples :
5702 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5703 mode http
5704 option httplog
5705 option logasap
5706 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5707
5708 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5709 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5710 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5711 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005714 logging.
5715
5716
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005717option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005718 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5720 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005721 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005722 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5723 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005724 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005725
5726 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5727 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5728 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5729 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5730 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5731 in the MySQL table, like this :
5732
5733 USE mysql;
5734 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5735 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5736
5737 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5738 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5739 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5740 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5741 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5742 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5743 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5744 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5745 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5746
5747 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5748 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005749
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005750 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005751
5752 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5753 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5754 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5755 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005756 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5757 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005758
5759 See also: "option httpchk"
5760
5761
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005762option nolinger
5763no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005764 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5766 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005767 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005768
5769 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5770 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5771 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5772 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5773 connections.
5774
5775 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5776 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5777 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5778 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5779 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5780 this too.
5781
5782 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5783 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5784 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5785
5786 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5787 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5788 for servers.
5789
5790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5792
5793
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005794option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5795 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | yes | yes | yes
5798 Arguments :
5799 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5800 matching <network>
5801 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5802 header name.
5803
5804 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5805 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5806 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5807 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5808 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5809 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5810 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5811 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5812 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5813 possible that the client has already brought one.
5814
5815 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5816 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5817 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5818 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5819 header and requires different one.
5820
5821 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5822 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5823 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5824 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5825 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5826 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5827 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5828
5829 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5830 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5831 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5832 both are defined.
5833
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005834 Examples :
5835 # Original Destination address
5836 frontend www
5837 mode http
5838 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5839
5840 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5841 backend www
5842 mode http
5843 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5844
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005845 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5846 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005847
5848
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005849option persist
5850no option persist
5851 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5853 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005854 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005855
5856 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5857 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5858 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5859 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5860 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5861 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5862 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5863 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5864 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5865 redirected to another valid server.
5866
5867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5869
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005870 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005871
5872
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005873option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5874 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 yes | no | yes | yes
5877 Arguments :
5878 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5879 PostgreSQL server.
5880
5881 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5882 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5883 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5884 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5885
5886 See also: "option httpchk"
5887
5888
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005889option prefer-last-server
5890no option prefer-last-server
5891 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5892 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5893 yes | no | yes | yes
5894 Arguments : none
5895
5896 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5897 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5898 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5899 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5900 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5901 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5902 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5903 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5904 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005905 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5906 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5907 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5908 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5909 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5910 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5911 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005912
5913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5915
5916 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5917
5918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005919option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005920option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005921no option redispatch
5922 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5924 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005925 Arguments :
5926 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5927 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5928 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5929 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5930 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5931 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5932 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5933 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5934 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005936
5937 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5938 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5939 be able to access the service anymore.
5940
5941 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5942 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5943
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005944 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005945 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5946 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005948 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5949 "redisp" keywords.
5950
5951 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5952 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5953
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005954 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005955
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005956
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005957option redis-check
5958 Use redis health checks for server testing
5959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5960 yes | no | yes | yes
5961 Arguments : none
5962
5963 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5964 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5965 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5966 find the "+PONG" response message.
5967
5968 Example :
5969 option redis-check
5970
5971 See also : "option httpchk"
5972
5973
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005974option smtpchk
5975option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5976 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005979 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005980 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5981 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5982 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5983
5984 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5985 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5986 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5987
5988 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5989 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5990 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5991 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5992 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5993 dead server.
5994
5995 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5996 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5997 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5998 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5999
6000 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6001 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6002 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6003 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006004 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006005
6006 Example :
6007 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6008
6009 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006012option socket-stats
6013no option socket-stats
6014
6015 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 yes | yes | yes | no
6018
6019 Arguments : none
6020
6021
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006022option splice-auto
6023no option splice-auto
6024 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | yes | yes | yes
6027 Arguments : none
6028
6029 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6030 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6031 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6032 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006033 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006034 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6035 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6036 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6037 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6038
6039 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6040 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6041 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6042 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6043 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6044 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6045 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6046 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6047 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6048 keyword.
6049
6050 Example :
6051 option splice-auto
6052
6053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6055
6056 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6057 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6058
6059
6060option splice-request
6061no option splice-request
6062 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6064 yes | yes | yes | yes
6065 Arguments : none
6066
6067 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006068 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006069 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6070 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6071 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6072 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6073
6074 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6075
6076 Example :
6077 option splice-request
6078
6079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6081
6082 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6083 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6084
6085
6086option splice-response
6087no option splice-response
6088 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6090 yes | yes | yes | yes
6091 Arguments : none
6092
6093 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006094 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006095 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6096 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6097 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6098 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6099
6100 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6101
6102 Example :
6103 option splice-response
6104
6105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6107
6108 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6109 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6110
6111
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006112option srvtcpka
6113no option srvtcpka
6114 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | no | yes | yes
6117 Arguments : none
6118
6119 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6120 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6121 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6122 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6123
6124 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6125 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6126 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6127 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6128
6129 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6130 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6131 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6132 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6133 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6134
6135 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6136
6137 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6138 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6139 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6140
6141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6143
6144 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6145
6146
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006147option ssl-hello-chk
6148 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6150 yes | no | yes | yes
6151 Arguments : none
6152
6153 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6154 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6155 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6156 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6157 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6158 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6159 hello message.
6160
6161 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6162 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6163 messages, which is appreciable.
6164
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006165 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6166 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6167 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006168
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006169 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6170
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006171
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006172option tcp-check
6173 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | no | yes | yes
6176
6177 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6178 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6179
6180 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6181 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6182 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6183
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006184 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006185 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6186 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6187 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6188 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6189 only.
6190
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006191 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006192 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6193 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6194 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6195 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006197 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006198 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6199 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006200 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006201 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6202 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6203 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6204 the respective protocols.
6205 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6206 analysed.
6207
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006208 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6209 script.
6210
6211 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6212 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6213 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6214 The "comment" is of course optional.
6215
6216
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006217 Examples :
6218 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6219 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006220 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006221
6222 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6223 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006224 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006225
6226 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6227 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006228 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006229 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006230 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006231 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006232 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006233 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006234 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6235 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006236 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006237 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6238 tcp-check expect string +OK
6239
6240 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6241 (send many headers before analyzing)
6242 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006243 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006244 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6245 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6246 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6247 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006248 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006249
6250
6251 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6252
6253
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006254option tcp-smart-accept
6255no option tcp-smart-accept
6256 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6258 yes | yes | yes | no
6259 Arguments : none
6260
6261 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6262 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6263 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6264 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6265 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6266 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6267
6268 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6269 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6270 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6271 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6272
6273 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6274 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6275 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6276 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6277
6278 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6279 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6280 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6281
6282 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6283 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6284 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6285
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006286 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6287
6288
6289option tcp-smart-connect
6290no option tcp-smart-connect
6291 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | no | yes | yes
6294 Arguments : none
6295
6296 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6297 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6298 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6299 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6300 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6301
6302 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6303 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6304 complex.
6305
6306 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6307 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6308 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6309
6310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6312
6313 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6314
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006316option tcpka
6317 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 yes | yes | yes | yes
6320 Arguments : none
6321
6322 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6323 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6324 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6325 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6326
6327 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6328 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6329 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6330 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6331
6332 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6333 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6334 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6335 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6336 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6337
6338 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6339
6340 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6341 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6342 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6343 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6344 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6345 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6346 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6347 backends.
6348
6349 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6350
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006351
6352option tcplog
6353 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | yes | yes | yes
6356 Arguments : none
6357
6358 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6359 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6360 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6361 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6362 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6363 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6364 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6365 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6366
6367 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006369 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006370
6371
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006372option transparent
6373no option transparent
6374 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006376 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006377 Arguments : none
6378
6379 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6380 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6381 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6382 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6383 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6384 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6385 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6386 appropriate server.
6387
6388 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6389 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6390
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006391 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006392 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006393
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006394
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006395external-check command <command>
6396 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6398 yes | no | yes | yes
6399
6400 Arguments :
6401 <command> is the external command to run
6402
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006403 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6404
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006405 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006406
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006407 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6408 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6409 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6410 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6411 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6412 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006413
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006414 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6415
6416 Environment variables :
6417 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6418 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6419
6420 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6421
6422 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6423
6424 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6425 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6426 for a UNIX socket).
6427
6428 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6429
6430 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6431
6432 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6433
6434 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6435
6436 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6437
6438 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6439 socket).
6440
6441 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6442 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6443
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006444 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6445 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6446 failed.
6447
6448 Example :
6449 external-check command /bin/true
6450
6451 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6452
6453
6454external-check path <path>
6455 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | no | yes | yes
6458
6459 Arguments :
6460 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6461
6462 The default path is "".
6463
6464 Example :
6465 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6466
6467 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6468 "external-check command"
6469
6470
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006471persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006472persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006473 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6475 yes | no | yes | yes
6476 Arguments :
6477 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006478 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6479 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006480
6481 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6482 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6483 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6484 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6485 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6486 forwarded to this server.
6487
6488 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6489 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6490 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006491 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006492 a single "listen" section.
6493
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006494 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6495 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6496 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6497
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006498 Example :
6499 listen tse-farm
6500 bind :3389
6501 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6502 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6503 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6504 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6505 persist rdp-cookie
6506 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006507 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006508 balance rdp-cookie
6509 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6510 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6511
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006512 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6513 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006514
6515
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006516rate-limit sessions <rate>
6517 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6519 yes | yes | yes | no
6520 Arguments :
6521 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6522 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6523
6524 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6525 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6526 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6527 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6528 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6529 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6530
6531 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6532 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6533 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6534 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6535
6536 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6537 listen smtp
6538 mode tcp
6539 bind :25
6540 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006541 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006542
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006543 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6544 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6545 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006546
6547 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6548
6549
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006550redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6551redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6552redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006553 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6555 no | yes | yes | yes
6556
6557 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006558 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006559
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006561 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006562 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6563 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6564 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006565
6566 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6567 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6568 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6569 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6570 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006571 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6572 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6573 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6574 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006575
6576 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6577 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6578 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6579 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6580 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6581 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006582 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006583 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006584 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6585 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6586 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006587
6588 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006589 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6590 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6591 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006592 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006593 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6594 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6595 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6596 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006597
6598 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6599 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6600
6601 - "drop-query"
6602 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6603 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6604 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6605 with a location-type redirect.
6606
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006607 - "append-slash"
6608 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6609 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6610 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6611 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6612
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006613 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6614 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6615 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6616 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6617 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6618 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6619 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6620
6621 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6622 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6623 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6624 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6625 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6626 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6627 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006628
6629 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6630 acl clear dst_port 80
6631 acl secure dst_port 8080
6632 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006633 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006634 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006635 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6636
6637 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006638 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6639 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6640 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006641 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006642
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006643 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6644 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6645 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6646
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006647 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006648 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006649
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006650 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6651 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6652 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006654 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006655
6656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006657redisp (deprecated)
6658redispatch (deprecated)
6659 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6661 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006662 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006663
6664 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6665 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6666 be able to access the service anymore.
6667
6668 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6669 redistribute them to a working server.
6670
6671 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6672 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6673 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006675 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6676 "option redispatch" instead.
6677
6678 See also : "option redispatch"
6679
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006680
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006681reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006682 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 no | yes | yes | yes
6685 Arguments :
6686 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6687 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006688 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006689
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006690 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6691 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6692
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006693 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6694 the last header of an HTTP request.
6695
6696 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6697 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6698 responses.
6699
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006700 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6701 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6702 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6703
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006704 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6705 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006706
6707
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006708reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6709reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006710 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 no | yes | yes | yes
6713 Arguments :
6714 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6715 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6716 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6717 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6718 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6719 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6720 ignores case.
6721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006725 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6726 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6727 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6728 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006729 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006730
6731 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6732 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6733
6734 Example :
6735 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6736 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6737 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6738
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006739 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6740 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006741
6742
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006743reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6744reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006745 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6747 no | yes | yes | yes
6748 Arguments :
6749 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6750 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6751 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6752 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6753 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6754 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6755
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006756 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6757 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6758
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006759 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6760 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6761 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6762 next servers.
6763
6764 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6765 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6766 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6767
6768 Example :
6769 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6770 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6771 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6772
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006773 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6774 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006775
6776
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006777reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6778reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006779 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 no | yes | yes | yes
6782 Arguments :
6783 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6784 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6785 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6786 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6787 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6788 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6789 case.
6790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006791 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6792 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6793
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006794 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6795 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6796 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6797 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006798 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006799
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006800 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006801 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006802 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006803
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006804 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6805 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6806
6807 Example :
6808 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6809 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6810 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6811
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006812 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6813 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006814
6815
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006816reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6817reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006818 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 no | yes | yes | yes
6821 Arguments :
6822 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6823 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6824 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6825 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6826 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6827 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6828 case.
6829
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006830 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6831 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6832
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006833 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6834 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6835 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6836 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6837
6838 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6839 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6840
6841 Example :
6842 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6843 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6844 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6845 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6846
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006847 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6848 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006849
6850
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006851reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6852reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006853 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6855 no | yes | yes | yes
6856 Arguments :
6857 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6858 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6859 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6860 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6861 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6862 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6863
6864 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6865 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6866 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6867 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006868 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006869
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006870 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6871 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6872
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006873 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6874 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6875 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6876
6877 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6878 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6879 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6880 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6881 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6882
6883 Example :
6884 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006885 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006886 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6887 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6888
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006889 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6890 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006891
6892
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006893reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6894reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006895 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 no | yes | yes | yes
6898 Arguments :
6899 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6900 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6901 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6902 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6903 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6904 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6905 ignores case.
6906
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006907 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6908 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6909
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006910 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6911 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006912 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6913 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6914 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006915 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6916 not set.
6917
6918 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6919 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6920 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6921 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6922 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6923
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006924 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006925 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6926 # block all others.
6927 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6928 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6929
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006930 # block bad guys
6931 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6932 reqitarpit . if badguys
6933
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006934 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
6935 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006936
6937
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006938retries <value>
6939 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | no | yes | yes
6942 Arguments :
6943 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6944 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6945 default value is 3.
6946
6947 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6948 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6949 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6950
6951 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006952 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6953 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006954
6955 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6956 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6957
6958 See also : "option redispatch"
6959
6960
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006961rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006962 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6964 no | yes | yes | yes
6965 Arguments :
6966 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6967 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006968 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006969
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006970 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6971 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6972
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006973 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6974 the last header of an HTTP response.
6975
6976 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6977 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6978 responses.
6979
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006980 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
6981 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006982
6983
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006984rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6985rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006986 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 no | yes | yes | yes
6989 Arguments :
6990 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6991 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6992 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6993 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6994 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6995 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6996 ignores case.
6997
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006998 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6999 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7000
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007001 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7002 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007003 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007004 client.
7005
7006 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7007 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7008 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7009
7010 Example :
7011 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007012 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007013
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007014 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7015 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007016
7017
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007018rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7019rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007020 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7022 no | yes | yes | yes
7023 Arguments :
7024 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7025 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7026 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7027 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7028 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7029 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7030 ignores case.
7031
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007032 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7033 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7034
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007035 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7036 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7037 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7038 case-sensitive.
7039
7040 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007041 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7042 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7043 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007044
7045 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7046 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7047
7048 Example :
7049 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7050 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7051
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007052 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7053 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007054
7055
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007056rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7057rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007058 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 no | yes | yes | yes
7061 Arguments :
7062 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7063 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7064 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7065 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7066 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7067 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7068 ignores case.
7069
7070 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7071 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7072 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7073 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007074 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007075
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007076 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7077 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7078
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007079 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7080 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7081 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7082
7083 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7084 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7085 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7086 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7087 are not case-sensitive.
7088
7089 Example :
7090 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7091 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7092
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007093 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7094 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007095
7096
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007097server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007098 Declare a server in a backend
7099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7100 no | no | yes | yes
7101 Arguments :
7102 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007103 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007104 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007105
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007106 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7107 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7108 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7109 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007110 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7111 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7112 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7113 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7114 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007115 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7116 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7117 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7118 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7119 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7120 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7121 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007122 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007123 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7124 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7125 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007127 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007128 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7129 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7130 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7131 adding this value to the client's port.
7132
7133 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7134 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007135 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007136
7137 Examples :
7138 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7139 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007140 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007141 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7142 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7143 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007144
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007145 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7146 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7147 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7148 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7149 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7150
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007151 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7152 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007153
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007154server-state-file-name [<file>]
7155 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7156 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7157 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7158 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7159 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7160 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7161
7162 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7163 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7164
7165 global
7166 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7167
7168 backend bk
7169 load-server-state-from-file
7170
7171 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7172 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007173
7174source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007175source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007176source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007177 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 yes | no | yes | yes
7180 Arguments :
7181 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7182 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007183
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007184 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007185 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7186 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7187 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7188 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7189 supported prefixes are :
7190 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7191 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7192 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007193 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007194 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7195 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007196
7197 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7198 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007199 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7200 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7201 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007202
7203 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7204 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7205 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7206 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7207 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7208 <addr>.
7209
7210 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7211 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7212 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7213 port.
7214
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007215 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7216 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7217 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7218 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007219 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007220 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7221 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7222 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7223 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7224 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7225 HTTP header.
7226
7227 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7228 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007229 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007230 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7231 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7232 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7233 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7234 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7235 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7236 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7237
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007238 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7239 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7240 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7241 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7242 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7243 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7244
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007245 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7246 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7247 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7248 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7249
7250 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7251 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7252 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7253 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7254 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7255 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7256
7257 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7258 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7259 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7260 there are two methods :
7261
7262 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7263 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7264 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7265 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7266 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7267 of the client ranges may be used.
7268
7269 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7270 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7271 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7272 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7273 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7274 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7275 same session.
7276
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007277 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7278 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7279 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007280 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007281
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007282 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007284 Examples :
7285 backend private
7286 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7287 source 192.168.1.200
7288
7289 backend transparent_ssl1
7290 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7291 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7292
7293 backend transparent_ssl2
7294 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7295 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7296 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7297
7298 backend transparent_ssl3
7299 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7300 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7301 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7302
7303 backend transparent_smtp
7304 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7305 # with Tproxy version 4.
7306 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7307
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007308 backend transparent_http
7309 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7310 # proxy.
7311 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007313 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007314 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007316
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007317srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7318 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7320 yes | no | yes | yes
7321 Arguments :
7322 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7323 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7324 as explained at the top of this document.
7325
7326 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7327 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7328 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7329 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7330 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7331 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7332 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7333
7334 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7335 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7336 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7337 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7338 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007339 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007340 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007341 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007342
7343 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7344 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7345 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7346 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7347 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7348 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7349
7350 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7351 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7352
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007353 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7354 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007355
7356
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007357stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7358 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007360 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007361
7362 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7363 matched.
7364
7365 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7366 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7367
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007368 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7369 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7370 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7371
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007372 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7373 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7374 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7375 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007376
7377 Example :
7378 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7379 backend stats_localhost
7380 stats enable
7381 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7382
7383 Example :
7384 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7385 backend stats_auth
7386 stats enable
7387 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7388 stats admin if TRUE
7389
7390 Example :
7391 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7392 userlist stats-auth
7393 group admin users admin
7394 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7395 group readonly users haproxy
7396 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7397
7398 backend stats_auth
7399 stats enable
7400 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7401 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7402 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7403 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7404
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007405 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7406 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7407 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007408
7409
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007410stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7411 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007413 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007414 Arguments :
7415 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7416
7417 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7418
7419 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7420 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7421 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7422 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7423 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7424 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7425
7426 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7427 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7428 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007429 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007430
7431 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7432 report using "stats scope".
7433
7434 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7435 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7436 unobvious parameters.
7437
7438 Example :
7439 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7440 backend public_www
7441 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7442 stats enable
7443 stats hide-version
7444 stats scope .
7445 stats uri /admin?stats
7446 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7447 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7448 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7449
7450 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7451 backend private_monitoring
7452 stats enable
7453 stats uri /admin?stats
7454 stats refresh 5s
7455
7456 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7457
7458
7459stats enable
7460 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007462 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007463 Arguments : none
7464
7465 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7466 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7467 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7468 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7469 - stats auth : no authentication
7470 - stats scope : no restriction
7471
7472 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7473 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7474 unobvious parameters.
7475
7476 Example :
7477 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7478 backend public_www
7479 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7480 stats enable
7481 stats hide-version
7482 stats scope .
7483 stats uri /admin?stats
7484 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7485 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7486 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7487
7488 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7489 backend private_monitoring
7490 stats enable
7491 stats uri /admin?stats
7492 stats refresh 5s
7493
7494 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7495
7496
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007497stats hide-version
7498 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007500 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007501 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007502
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007503 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7504 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7505 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7506 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7507 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7508 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007510 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7511 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7512 unobvious parameters.
7513
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007514 Example :
7515 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7516 backend public_www
7517 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007518 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007519 stats hide-version
7520 stats scope .
7521 stats uri /admin?stats
7522 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7523 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7524 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007525
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7527 backend private_monitoring
7528 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007529 stats uri /admin?stats
7530 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007531
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007532 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007533
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007534
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007535stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7536 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7537 Access control for statistics
7538
7539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7540 no | no | yes | yes
7541
7542 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7543 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7544 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7545 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7546 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7547 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7548
7549 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7550 instance.
7551
7552 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7553 about ACL usage.
7554
7555
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007556stats realm <realm>
7557 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007559 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007560 Arguments :
7561 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7562 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7563 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7564
7565 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7566 using a backslash ('\').
7567
7568 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7569 only related to authentication.
7570
7571 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7572 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7573 unobvious parameters.
7574
7575 Example :
7576 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7577 backend public_www
7578 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7579 stats enable
7580 stats hide-version
7581 stats scope .
7582 stats uri /admin?stats
7583 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7584 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7585 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7586
7587 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7588 backend private_monitoring
7589 stats enable
7590 stats uri /admin?stats
7591 stats refresh 5s
7592
7593 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7594
7595
7596stats refresh <delay>
7597 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007599 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007600 Arguments :
7601 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7602 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7603 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7604 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7605 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7606 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7607
7608 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7609 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7610 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7611 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7612
7613 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7614 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7615 unobvious parameters.
7616
7617 Example :
7618 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7619 backend public_www
7620 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7621 stats enable
7622 stats hide-version
7623 stats scope .
7624 stats uri /admin?stats
7625 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7626 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7627 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7628
7629 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7630 backend private_monitoring
7631 stats enable
7632 stats uri /admin?stats
7633 stats refresh 5s
7634
7635 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7636
7637
7638stats scope { <name> | "." }
7639 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007641 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007642 Arguments :
7643 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7644 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7645 section in which the statement appears.
7646
7647 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7648 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7649 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7650 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7651 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7652 exists.
7653
7654 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7655 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7656 unobvious parameters.
7657
7658 Example :
7659 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7660 backend public_www
7661 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7662 stats enable
7663 stats hide-version
7664 stats scope .
7665 stats uri /admin?stats
7666 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7667 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7668 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7669
7670 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7671 backend private_monitoring
7672 stats enable
7673 stats uri /admin?stats
7674 stats refresh 5s
7675
7676 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007678
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007679stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007680 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007682 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007683
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007684 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007685 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7686
7687 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7688 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7689
7690 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7691 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007692 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007693
7694 Example :
7695 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7696 backend private_monitoring
7697 stats enable
7698 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7699 stats uri /admin?stats
7700 stats refresh 5s
7701
7702 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7703 global section.
7704
7705
7706stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007707 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7709 yes | yes | yes | yes
7710 Arguments : none
7711
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007712 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007713 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7714 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7715 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7716 - IP (socket, server)
7717 - cookie (backend, server)
7718
7719 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7720 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007721 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007722
7723 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7724
7725
7726stats show-node [ <name> ]
7727 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007729 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007730 Arguments:
7731 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7732 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7733
7734 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7735 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007736 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007737
7738 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7739 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7740 unobvious parameters.
7741
7742 Example:
7743 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7744 backend private_monitoring
7745 stats enable
7746 stats show-node Europe-1
7747 stats uri /admin?stats
7748 stats refresh 5s
7749
7750 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7751 section.
7752
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007753
7754stats uri <prefix>
7755 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007757 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007758 Arguments :
7759 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7760 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7761 query string.
7762
7763 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7764 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7765 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7766 possible to reach it in the application.
7767
7768 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007769 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007770 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7771 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7772 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7773 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7774
7775 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7776 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7777 an address or a port to statistics only.
7778
7779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7781 unobvious parameters.
7782
7783 Example :
7784 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7785 backend public_www
7786 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7787 stats enable
7788 stats hide-version
7789 stats scope .
7790 stats uri /admin?stats
7791 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7792 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7793 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7794
7795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7796 backend private_monitoring
7797 stats enable
7798 stats uri /admin?stats
7799 stats refresh 5s
7800
7801 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7802
7803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007804stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7805 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007807 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007808
7809 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007810 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007811 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7812 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7813 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7814
7815 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7816 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7817 the "stick-table" statement.
7818
7819 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7820 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7821 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7822 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7823 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7824
7825 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7826 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7827 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7828 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7829 transformation rules.
7830
7831 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7832 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7833 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7834 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7835 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7836 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7837 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7838
7839 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7840 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7841 ACL based conditions.
7842
7843 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7844 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7845 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7846 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7847
7848 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7849 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7850 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7851 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7852
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007853 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7854 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7855 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7856
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007857 Example :
7858 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7859 # last 30 minutes
7860 backend pop
7861 mode tcp
7862 balance roundrobin
7863 stick store-request src
7864 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7865 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7866 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7867
7868 backend smtp
7869 mode tcp
7870 balance roundrobin
7871 stick match src table pop
7872 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7873 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7874
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007875 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007876 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007877
7878
7879stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7880 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 no | no | yes | yes
7883
7884 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7885 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7886 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7887 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7888
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007889 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7890 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7891 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7892
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007893 Examples :
7894 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007895 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007896
7897 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7898 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7899 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7900
7901
7902 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7903 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7904 backend http
7905 mode http
7906 balance roundrobin
7907 stick on src table https
7908 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7909 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7910 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7911
7912 backend https
7913 mode tcp
7914 balance roundrobin
7915 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7916 stick on src
7917 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7918 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7919
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007920 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007921
7922
7923stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7924 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 no | no | yes | yes
7927
7928 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007929 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007930 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7931 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7932 server is selected.
7933
7934 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7935 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7936 the "stick-table" statement.
7937
7938 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7939 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7940 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7941 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7942 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7943 address.
7944
7945 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7946 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7947 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7948 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7949 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7950 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7951 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7952 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7953 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7954 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7955
7956 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7957 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7958 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7959 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7960 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7961 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7962 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7963
7964 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7965 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7966 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7967 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7968
7969 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7970 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7971 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7972 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7973 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7974 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007975 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7976 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7977 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7978 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7979 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7980 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007981
7982 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7983 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7984 the request.
7985
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007986 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7987 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7988 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7989
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007990 Example :
7991 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7992 # last 30 minutes
7993 backend pop
7994 mode tcp
7995 balance roundrobin
7996 stick store-request src
7997 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7998 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7999 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8000
8001 backend smtp
8002 mode tcp
8003 balance roundrobin
8004 stick match src table pop
8005 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8006 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8007
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008008 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008009 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008010
8011
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008012stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008013 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8014 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008015 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008017 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008018
8019 Arguments :
8020 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8021 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8022 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8023 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8024
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008025 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8026 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8027 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8028 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8029
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008030 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8031 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8032 instance.
8033
8034 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8035 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8036 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8037 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8038 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8039 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008040 to 32 characters.
8041
8042 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8043 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8044 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008045 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008046 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8047 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008048
8049 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008050 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8051 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008052 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8053 increase.
8054
8055 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008056 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8057 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8058 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008059
8060 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8061 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8062 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8063 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8064 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8065 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8066 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8067 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8068 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8069 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8070 parameter (see below).
8071
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008072 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8073 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8074 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8075 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8076 soft restart.
8077
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008078 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8079 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008080
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008081 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8082 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8083 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8084 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8085 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008086 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008087 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8088 if not expiration delay is specified.
8089
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008090 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8091 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8092 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8093 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008094 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8095 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8096 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8097 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8098 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8099 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8100 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8101 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8102 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8103 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8104 types and their arguments.
8105
8106 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8107 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8108 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8109 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8110
8111 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8112 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8113 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8114 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8115
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008116 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8117 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8118 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8119 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8120 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8121 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8122
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008123 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8124 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8125 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8126 they were received.
8127
8128 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8129 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8130 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8131 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8132 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8133
8134 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8135 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8136 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8137 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8138 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8139
8140 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8141 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8142 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8143
8144 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8145 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8146 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8147 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8148 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8149
8150 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8151 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8152 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8153 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8154 the client side.
8155
8156 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8157 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8158 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8159 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8160 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8161 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8162 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8163
8164 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8165 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8166 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8167 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8168 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8169 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8170 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8171
8172 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8173 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8174 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8175 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8176 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8177 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8178
8179 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8180 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8181 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8182 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8183
8184 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8185 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8186 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8187 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8188 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8189 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8190 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8191 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8192 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8193 recommended for better fairness.
8194
8195 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8196 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8197 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8198 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8199
8200 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8201 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8202 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8203 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8204 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8205 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8206 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8207 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8208 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8209 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008210
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008211 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8212 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008213 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8214 reference it.
8215
8216 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8217 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
8218 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
8219 as an exclusive stickiness.
8220
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008221 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8222 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8223 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8224 something that can be ignored.
8225
8226 Example:
8227 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8228 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8229 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8230 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8231
8232 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008233 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008234
8235
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008236stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8237 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8239 no | no | yes | yes
8240
8241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008242 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008243 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8244 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8245 server is selected.
8246
8247 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8248 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8249 the "stick-table" statement.
8250
8251 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8252 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8253 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8254 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8255
8256 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8257 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8258 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8259 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8260 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8261 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008262 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008263 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8264 rules.
8265
8266 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8267 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8268 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8269 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8270 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8271 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8272 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8273
8274 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8275 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8276 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8277 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8278
8279 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8280 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8281 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8282 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8283 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8284 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008285 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8286 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8287 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8288 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8289 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8290 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8291 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8292 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8293 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008294
8295 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8296
8297 Example :
8298 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8299 backend https
8300 mode tcp
8301 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008302 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008303 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008304
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008305 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8306 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8307
8308 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8309 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8310 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8311
8312 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8313 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008314
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008315 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8316 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8317 # at offset 44.
8318
8319 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8320 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8321
8322 # Learn on response if server hello.
8323 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008324
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008325 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8326 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8327
8328 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8329 extraction.
8330
8331
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008332tcp-check connect [params*]
8333 Opens a new connection
8334 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8335 no | no | yes | yes
8336
8337 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8338 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8339 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8340
8341 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8342 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8343 of the sequence.
8344
8345 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8346 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8347 do.
8348
8349 Parameters :
8350 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8351 use the TCP connection.
8352
8353 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8354 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8355 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8356
8357 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8358
8359 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8360
8361 Examples:
8362 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8363 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8364 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8365 option tcp-check
8366 tcp-check connect
8367 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8368 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8369 tcp-check send \r\n
8370 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8371 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8372 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8373 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8374 tcp-check send \r\n
8375 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8376 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8377
8378 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8379 option tcp-check
8380 tcp-check connect port 110
8381 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8382 tcp-check connect port 143
8383 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8384 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8385
8386 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8387
8388
8389tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8390 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8391 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8392 no | no | yes | yes
8393
8394 Arguments :
8395 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8396 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8397 binary.
8398 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8399 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8400 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8401
8402 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8403 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8404 with the usual backslash ('\').
8405 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8406 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8407 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8408 used upper or lower case.
8409
8410
8411 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8412
8413 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8414 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8415 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8416 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8417 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8418 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8419 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8420 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8421
8422 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8423 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8424 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8425 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8426 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8427 expression.
8428
8429 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8430 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8431 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8432 this exact hexadecimal string.
8433 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8434
8435 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8436 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8437 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8438 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8439 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8440 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8441 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8442 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8443 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8444 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8445 the null character.
8446
8447 Examples :
8448 # perform a POP check
8449 option tcp-check
8450 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8451
8452 # perform an IMAP check
8453 option tcp-check
8454 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8455
8456 # look for the redis master server
8457 option tcp-check
8458 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008459 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008460 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8461 tcp-check expect string role:master
8462 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8463 tcp-check expect string +OK
8464
8465
8466 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8467 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8468
8469
8470tcp-check send <data>
8471 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8473 no | no | yes | yes
8474
8475 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8476 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8477
8478 Examples :
8479 # look for the redis master server
8480 option tcp-check
8481 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8482 tcp-check expect string role:master
8483
8484 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8485 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8486
8487
8488tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8489 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8490 tcp health check
8491 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 no | no | yes | yes
8493
8494 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8495 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8496 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8497 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8498 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8499 hexadecimal string.
8500 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8501
8502 Examples :
8503 # redis check in binary
8504 option tcp-check
8505 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8506 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8507
8508
8509 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8510 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8511
8512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008513tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8514 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8516 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008517 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008518 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8519 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008521 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008522
8523 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8524 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008525 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8526 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8527 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8528 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8529 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8530 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008532 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8533 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8534 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8535 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008536
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008537 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008538 - accept :
8539 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8540 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8541 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008543 - reject :
8544 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8545 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8546 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8547 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8548 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8549 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8550 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8551 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8552 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8553 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8554 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8555 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008556
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008557 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8558 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8559 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8560 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8561 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8562 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8563 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8564 hosts.
8565
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008566 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8567 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8568 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8569 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8570 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8571 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8572 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8573 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8574 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008575 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8576 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008577
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008578 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008579 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008580 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008581 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008582 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8583 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008584 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008585 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8586 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8587 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8588 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8589 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008590
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008591 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008592 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008593 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008594 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8595 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8596 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8597 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008599 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8600 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8601 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8602 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008604 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8605 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8606 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8607 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8608 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008609 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8610 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8611 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8612 layer7 information is extracted.
8613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008614 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8615 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8616 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8617 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8618 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008619
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008620 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8621 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8622 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8623 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8624
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008625 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8626 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8627 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8628 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8629 continues.
8630
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008631 - "silent-drop" :
8632 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8633 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8634 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8635 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8636 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8637 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8638 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8639 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8640 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8641 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8642 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8643 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8644 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8645 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8646 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8647 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8648
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008649 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8650 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8651 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008652
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008653 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8654 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8655 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008657 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008658 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008659 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008661 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8662 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8663 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008665 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008666 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8667 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008668
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008669 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8670
8671 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8672
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008673 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8674
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008675 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008676
8677
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008678tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8679 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008681 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008682 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008683 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8684 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008685
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008686 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008687
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008688 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8689 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8690 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8691 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8692 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008693
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008694 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8695 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8696 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8697 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008698 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8699 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8700 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8701 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8702 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8703 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008704 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008705 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008706
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008707 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8708 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8709 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8710 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008711
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008712 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008713 - accept : the request is accepted
8714 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8715 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008716 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008717 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008718 - set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008719 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008720 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008722 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8723 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008724
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008725 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8726 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8727 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8728 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8729 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8730 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008732 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008733 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8734 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008735
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008736 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008737 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8738 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8739 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8740 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008741 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8742 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8743 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008744
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008745 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008746 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8747 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8748 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008749
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008750 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8751 declared inline.
8752
8753 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8754 The allowed scopes are:
8755 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8756 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8757 (request and response)
8758 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8759 processing
8760 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8761 processing.
8762 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8763 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8764
8765 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8766 followed by some converters.
8767
8768 Example:
8769
8770 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8771
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008772 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008773 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8774 # and reject everything else.
8775 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8776 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008777 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008778 tcp-request content reject
8779
8780 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008781 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8782 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8783 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008784 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008785
8786 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8787 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8788 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008789 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008790 tcp-request content reject
8791
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008792 Example:
8793 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8794 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008795 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008796
8797 Example:
8798 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8799 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008800 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008802 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8803 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8804
8805 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008806 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008807 # protecting all our sites
8808 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008809 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8810 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008811 ...
8812 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8813
8814 backend http_dynamic
8815 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008816 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008817 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008818 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8819 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8820 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008821 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008824
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008825 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008826
8827
8828tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8829 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008831 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008832 Arguments :
8833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8835 as explained at the top of this document.
8836
8837 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8838 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8839 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8840 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8841 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8842
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008843 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8844 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8845 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8846 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8847
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008848 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8849 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008850 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008851 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008852 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8853 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8854 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8855 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008856
8857 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8858 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8859 it pass through unaffected.
8860
8861 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8862 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8863 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008864 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008865 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8866 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008867 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8868 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8869 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008870
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008871 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008872 "timeout client".
8873
8874
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008875tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8876 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8878 no | no | yes | yes
8879 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008880 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8881 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008882
8883 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8884
8885 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8886 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8887 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008888 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8889 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008890
8891 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8892
8893 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8894 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8895 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8896 inserted.
8897
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008898 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008899 - accept :
8900 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8901 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8902 the rules evaluation.
8903
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008904 - close :
8905 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8906 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8907 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8908 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8909 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8910 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008911 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008912 protocols.
8913
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008914 - reject :
8915 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8916 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008917 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008918
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008919 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8920 Sets a variable.
8921
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008922 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8923 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8924 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8925 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008927 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8928 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8929 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8930 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8931 continues.
8932
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008933 - "silent-drop" :
8934 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8935 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8936 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8937 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8938 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8939 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8940 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8941 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8942 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8943 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8944 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8945 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8946 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8947 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8948 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8949 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8950
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008951 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8952 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8953 for changing the default action to a reject.
8954
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008955 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8956 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8957 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8958 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008959 period.
8960
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008961 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8962 declared inline.
8963
8964 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8965 The allowed scopes are:
8966 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8967 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8968 (request and response)
8969 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8970 processing
8971 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8972 processing.
8973 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8974 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8975
8976 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8977 followed by some converters.
8978
8979 Example:
8980
8981 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8982
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008983 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8984
8985 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8986
8987
8988tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8989 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8991 no | no | yes | yes
8992 Arguments :
8993 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8994 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8995 as explained at the top of this document.
8996
8997 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8998
8999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009000timeout check <timeout>
9001 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9002 established.
9003
9004 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9005 yes | no | yes | yes
9006 Arguments:
9007 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9009 as explained at the top of this document.
9010
9011 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9012 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9013 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9014 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009015 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9016 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9017 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009018
9019 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9020 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9021
9022 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9023 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009024 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009025
9026 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9027 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9028 forget about it.
9029
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009030 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9031 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009032
9033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009034timeout client <timeout>
9035timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9036 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9038 yes | yes | yes | no
9039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009040 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9042 as explained at the top of this document.
9043
9044 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9045 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9046 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
9047 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
9048 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
9049 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9050 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9051 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009052 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009053 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009054 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9055 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009056 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9057 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009058
9059 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9060 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9061 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9062 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9063 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9064 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9065
9066 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9067 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9068 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9069
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009070 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009071
9072
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009073timeout client-fin <timeout>
9074 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9076 yes | yes | yes | no
9077 Arguments :
9078 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9079 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9080 as explained at the top of this document.
9081
9082 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9083 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9084 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9085 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9086 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9087 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9088 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9089 down in one direction.
9090
9091 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9092 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9093 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9094
9095 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9096
9097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009098timeout connect <timeout>
9099timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9100 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9102 yes | no | yes | yes
9103 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009104 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009105 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9106 as explained at the top of this document.
9107
9108 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009109 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009110 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009111 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009112 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9113 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009114
9115 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9116 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9117 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9118 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9119 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9120 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9121
9122 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9123 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9124 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9125
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009126 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9127 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009128
9129
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009130timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9131 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9133 yes | yes | yes | yes
9134 Arguments :
9135 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9136 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9137 as explained at the top of this document.
9138
9139 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9140 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9141 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9142 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9143 once the request has started to present itself.
9144
9145 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9146 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9147 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9148 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9149 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9150
9151 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9152 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9153 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9154 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9155
9156 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9157 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9158 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9159 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9160 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009161 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009162
9163 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9164 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9165 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9166 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9167
9168 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9169
9170
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009171timeout http-request <timeout>
9172 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009174 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009175 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9178 as explained at the top of this document.
9179
9180 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9181 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9182 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9183 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9184 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9185 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9186 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009187 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9188 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9189 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9190 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9191 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009192 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9193 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009194
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009195 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9196 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9197 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9198 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9199 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009200 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009201
9202 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9203 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9204 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9205 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9206 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9207
9208 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009209 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9210 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9211 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009212
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009213 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009214 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009215
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009216
9217timeout queue <timeout>
9218 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9220 yes | no | yes | yes
9221 Arguments :
9222 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9223 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9224 as explained at the top of this document.
9225
9226 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9227 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9228 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9229 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9230 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9231
9232 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9233 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9234 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9235 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9236
9237 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9238
9239
9240timeout server <timeout>
9241timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9242 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9244 yes | no | yes | yes
9245 Arguments :
9246 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9247 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9248 as explained at the top of this document.
9249
9250 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9251 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9252 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9253 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9254 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9255 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9256 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9257
9258 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9259 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9260 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9261 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9262 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009263 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009264 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009265 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9266 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9267 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9268 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009269
9270 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9271 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9272 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9273 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9274 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9275 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9276
9277 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9278 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9279 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9280
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009281 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009282
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009283
9284timeout server-fin <timeout>
9285 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9287 yes | no | yes | yes
9288 Arguments :
9289 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9290 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9291 as explained at the top of this document.
9292
9293 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9294 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9295 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9296 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9297 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9298 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9299 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9300 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9301 situations, it should not be needed.
9302
9303 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9304 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9305 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9306
9307 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9308
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009309
9310timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009311 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9313 yes | yes | yes | yes
9314 Arguments :
9315 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9317 as explained at the top of this document.
9318
9319 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9320 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9321 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9322
9323 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9324 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9325 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9326 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009327 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009328
9329 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9330
9331
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009332timeout tunnel <timeout>
9333 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9335 yes | no | yes | yes
9336 Arguments :
9337 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9339 as explained at the top of this document.
9340
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009341 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009342 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9343 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9344 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9345 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9346 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9347 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9348 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9349 specified.
9350
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009351 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9352 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9353 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9354 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9355 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9356 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9357 state.
9358
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009359 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9360 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9361 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9362 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9363 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9364
9365 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9366 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9367 forget about it.
9368
9369 Example :
9370 defaults http
9371 option http-server-close
9372 timeout connect 5s
9373 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009374 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009375 timeout server 30s
9376 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9377
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009378 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009379
9380
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009381transparent (deprecated)
9382 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009384 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009385 Arguments : none
9386
9387 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9388 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9389 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9390 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9391 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9392 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9393 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9394 appropriate server.
9395
9396 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9397
9398 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9399 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9400
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009401 See also: "option transparent"
9402
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009403unique-id-format <string>
9404 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9406 yes | yes | yes | no
9407 Arguments :
9408 <string> is a log-format string.
9409
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009410 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9411 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9412 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9413 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009414
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009415 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9416 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9417 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9418 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9419 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9420 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9421 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9422 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009423
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009424 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9425 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009426
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009427 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009428
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009429 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009430
9431 will generate:
9432
9433 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9434
9435 See also: "unique-id-header"
9436
9437unique-id-header <name>
9438 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9440 yes | yes | yes | no
9441 Arguments :
9442 <name> is the name of the header.
9443
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009444 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9445 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009446
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009447 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009448
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009449 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009450 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9451
9452 will generate:
9453
9454 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9455
9456 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009457
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009458use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009459 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9461 no | yes | yes | no
9462 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009463 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9464 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009465
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009466 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9467 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009468
9469 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9470 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9471 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009472 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9473 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9474 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9475 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009476
9477 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9478 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9479 assign the backend.
9480
9481 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9482 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9483 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9484 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9485 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9486 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9487
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009488 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009489 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009490 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9491 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9492 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9493
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009494 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9495 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9496 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9497 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9498 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9499 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9500 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9501 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9502 cannot be forced from the request.
9503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009504 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009505 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9506 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9507
9508 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9509 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009510
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009511
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009512use-server <server> if <condition>
9513use-server <server> unless <condition>
9514 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9516 no | no | yes | yes
9517 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009518 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009519
9520 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9521
9522 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9523 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9524 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9525
9526 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9527 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9528 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9529 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9530 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9531 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9532 matches will assign the server.
9533
9534 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9535 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9536 with the next rules until one matches.
9537
9538 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9539 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9540 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9541 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9542
9543 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9544 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9545 stripped.
9546
9547 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9548 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9549 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9550 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9551
9552 Example :
9553 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9554 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9555 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9556 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9557 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9558 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9559 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9560 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9561 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9562
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009563 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009564
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009565
95665. Bind and Server options
9567--------------------------
9568
9569The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9570depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9571settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9572written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9573described in this section.
9574
9575
95765.1. Bind options
9577-----------------
9578
9579The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9580as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9581no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9582parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9583while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9584provided immediately after the setting name.
9585
9586The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9587
9588accept-proxy
9589 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009590 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9591 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009592 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9593 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9594 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9595 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9596 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9597 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9598 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009599 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9600 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009601
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009602alpn <protocols>
9603 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9604 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9605 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9606 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9607 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9608 initial NPN extension.
9609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009610backlog <backlog>
9611 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9612 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9613
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009614ecdhe <named curve>
9615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009616 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9617 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009618
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009619ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009620 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9621 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9622 client's certificate.
9623
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009624ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9626 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9627 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9628 error is ignored.
9629
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009630ca-sign-file <cafile>
9631 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9632 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9633 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9634 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9635 'generate-certificates' for details.
9636
9637ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9639 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9640 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9641 'generate-certificates' for details.
9642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009643ciphers <ciphers>
9644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9645 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009646 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009647 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9648 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9649
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009650crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9652 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9653 to verify client's certificate.
9654
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009655crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9657 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9658 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9659 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9660 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9661 file.
9662
9663 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9664 are loaded.
9665
9666 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009667 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009668 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9669 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9670 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9671 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9672 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9673 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9674 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009675
9676 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9677 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9678 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9679 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009680 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9681 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009682
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009683 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009684
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009685 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9686 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009687 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009688 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9689 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9690 clients).
9691
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009692 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9693 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9694 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9695 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9696 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9697 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9698 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9699 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9700 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9701 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9702 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9703 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9704 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9705
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009706 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9707 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9708 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9709 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9710 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9711
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009712 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9713 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9714 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9715 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009716
9717 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9718 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9719 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9720 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9721 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9722 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9723 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9724 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9725 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9726
9727 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9728
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009729 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009730 a cert bundle.
9731
9732 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9733 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9734 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9735 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9736 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9737 provide multi-cert support.
9738
9739 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9740
9741 Filename | CN | SAN
9742 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9743 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009744 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009745 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9746 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9747
9748 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9749 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9750 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9751 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9752 suites.
9753
9754 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9755 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9756
9757 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9758 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9759 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9760
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009761crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9763 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009764 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009765 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009766
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009767crt-list <file>
9768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009769 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9770 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009771
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009772 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009773
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009774 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9775 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9776 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9777 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9778 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9779 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9780 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9781 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009782
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009783 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
9784 the base name is given in the crt-list. Due to the nature of bundling, all SNI
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009785 filters given to a multi-cert bundle entry are ignored.
9786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009787defer-accept
9788 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9789 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9790 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9791 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9792 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9793 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9794 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9795 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9796 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9797 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9798 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9799
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009800force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009801 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009802 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009803 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9804 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009805
9806force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009807 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009808 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9809 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009810
9811force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009812 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009813 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9814 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009815
9816force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009817 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009818 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9819 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009820
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009821generate-certificates
9822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9823 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9824 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9825 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9826 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9827 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9828 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9829 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9830 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9831 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9832 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9833
9834 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9835 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9836 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9837 certificate is used many times.
9838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009839gid <gid>
9840 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9841 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9842 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9843 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9844 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9845
9846group <group>
9847 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9848 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9849 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9850 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9851 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9852
9853id <id>
9854 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9855 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9856 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9857 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9858
9859interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009860 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9861 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9862 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9863 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9864 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9865 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9866 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009867
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009868level <level>
9869 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9870 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9871 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9872 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9873 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9874 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9875 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9876 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9877 counters).
9878 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9879 all counters).
9880
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009881maxconn <maxconn>
9882 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9883 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9884 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9885 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9886 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9887 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9888 eat all memory.
9889
9890mode <mode>
9891 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9892 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9893 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9894 UNIX sockets.
9895
9896mss <maxseg>
9897 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9898 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9899 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9900 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9901 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9902 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9903 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9904 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9905 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9906 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9907 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9908
9909name <name>
9910 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9911 page.
9912
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +02009913namespace <name>
9914 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
9915 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
9916 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
9917 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
9918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009919nice <nice>
9920 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9921 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9922 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9923 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9924 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9925 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9926 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9927 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9928 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9929 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9930 one for an RDP socket.
9931
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009932no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009934 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009935 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009936 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9937 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009938 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009939
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009940no-tls-tickets
9941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9942 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9943 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009944 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9945 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009946
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009947no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009949 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009950 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009951 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9952 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9953 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009954
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009955no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009957 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009958 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009959 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9960 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9961 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009962
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009963no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009965 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009966 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009967 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9968 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9969 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009970
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009971npn <protocols>
9972 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9973 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9974 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9975 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009976 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9977 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009978
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009979process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9980 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9981 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9982 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9983 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9984 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9985 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9986 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009987 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9988 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9989 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9990 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9991 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9992 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9993 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009994
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009995ssl
9996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009997 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009998 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9999 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10000 to deciphered contents.
10001
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010002strict-sni
10003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10004 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10005 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10006 See the "crt" option for more information.
10007
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010008tcp-ut <delay>
10009 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10010 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10011 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10012 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10013 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10014 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10015 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10016 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10017 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10018 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10019 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10020
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010021tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010022 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010023 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10024 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10025 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10026 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10027 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10028 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10029 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010030 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10031 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10032 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010033
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010034tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10035 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10036 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10037 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10038 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10039 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10040 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10041 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10042 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10043 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10044 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010046transparent
10047 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10048 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10049 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10050 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10051 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10052 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10053 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10054 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10055 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10056 so check for support with your vendor.
10057
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010058v4v6
10059 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10060 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10061 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10062 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010063 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010064
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010065v6only
10066 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10067 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10068 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010069 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10070 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010071
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010072uid <uid>
10073 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10074 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10075 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10076 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10077 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10078
10079user <user>
10080 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10081 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10082 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10083 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10084 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10085
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010086verify [none|optional|required]
10087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10088 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10089 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10090 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10091 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010092 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10093 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10094 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10095 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010096
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200100975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010098------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010100The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10101which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10102arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10103settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10104after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10105Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10106address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010108 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010109 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010111The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010112
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010113addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010114 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
10115 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
10116 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
10117 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
10118 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010120 Supported in default-server: No
10121
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010122agent-check
10123 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010124 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10125 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10126 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10127 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010128
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010129 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010130 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010131 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10132 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10133 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010134
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010135 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10136 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010137
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010138 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10139 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10140 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010141
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010142 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10143 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10144 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010145
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010146 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10147 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10148 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10149 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10150 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10151 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10152 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010153
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010154 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10155 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010156
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010157 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10158 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10159 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10160 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10161 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10162 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10163 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10164 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10165 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010166
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010167 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10168 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010169 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10170 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10171 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010172 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010173
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010174 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10175 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010176
10177 Supported in default-server: No
10178
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010179agent-send <string>
10180 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10181 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10182 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10183 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10184 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10185
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010186agent-inter <delay>
10187 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10188 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10189
10190 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10191 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10192 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10193 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10194 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10195 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10196 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10197 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10198 of backends use the same servers.
10199
10200 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10201
10202 Supported in default-server: Yes
10203
10204agent-port <port>
10205 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10206
10207 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10208
10209 Supported in default-server: Yes
10210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010211backup
10212 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10213 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10214 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10215 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10216 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10217 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010219 Supported in default-server: No
10220
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010221ca-file <cafile>
10222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10223 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10224 server's certificate.
10225
10226 Supported in default-server: No
10227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010228check
10229 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010230 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10231 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10232 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10233 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10234 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10235 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10236 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010237 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10238 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10239 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010241 Supported in default-server: No
10242
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010243check-send-proxy
10244 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10245 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10246 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10247 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10248 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10249 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10250 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10251
10252 Supported in default-server: No
10253
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010254check-ssl
10255 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10256 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10257 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10258 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010259 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010260 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10261 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10262 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10263 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10264
10265 Supported in default-server: No
10266
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010267ciphers <ciphers>
10268 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010269 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010270 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10271 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10272 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10273 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10274 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10275 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10276
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010277 Supported in default-server: No
10278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010279cookie <value>
10280 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10281 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10282 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10283 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10284 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10285 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10286 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010288 Supported in default-server: No
10289
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010290crl-file <crlfile>
10291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10292 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10293 to verify server's certificate.
10294
10295 Supported in default-server: No
10296
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010297crt <cert>
10298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10299 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10300 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10301 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10302 certificate request.
10303
10304 Supported in default-server: No
10305
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010306disabled
10307 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10308 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10309 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10310 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10311 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10312
10313 Supported in default-server: No
10314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010315error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010316 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10317 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10318 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010320 Supported in default-server: Yes
10321
10322 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010323
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010324fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010325 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10326 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10327 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010329 Supported in default-server: Yes
10330
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010331force-sslv3
10332 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10333 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010334 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10335 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010336
10337 Supported in default-server: No
10338
10339force-tlsv10
10340 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010341 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10342 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010343
10344 Supported in default-server: No
10345
10346force-tlsv11
10347 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010348 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10349 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010350
10351 Supported in default-server: No
10352
10353force-tlsv12
10354 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010355 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10356 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010357
10358 Supported in default-server: No
10359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010360id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010361 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10362 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10363 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010365 Supported in default-server: No
10366
10367inter <delay>
10368fastinter <delay>
10369downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010370 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10371 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10372 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10373 between checks depending on the server state :
10374
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010375 Server state | Interval used
10376 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10377 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10378 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10379 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10380 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10381 or yet unchecked. |
10382 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10383 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10384 | "inter" otherwise.
10385 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010387 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10388 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10389 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10390 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010391 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10392 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10393 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10394 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10395 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010397 Supported in default-server: Yes
10398
10399maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010400 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10401 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10402 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10403 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10404 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10405 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10406 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10407 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010409 Supported in default-server: Yes
10410
10411maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010412 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10413 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10414 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10415 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10416 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10417 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10418 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010420 Supported in default-server: Yes
10421
10422minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010423 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10424 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10425 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10426 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10427 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10428 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010429 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010430 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010432 Supported in default-server: Yes
10433
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010434namespace <name>
10435 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10436 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10437 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10438 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10439
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010440no-ssl-reuse
10441 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10442 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10443 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10444 and for paranoid users.
10445
10446 Supported in default-server: No
10447
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010448no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010449 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10450 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010451 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010452
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010453 Supported in default-server: No
10454
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010455no-tls-tickets
10456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10457 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10458 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010459 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10460 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010461
10462 Supported in default-server: No
10463
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010464no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010465 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010466 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10467 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010468 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10469 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10470 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010471
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010472 Supported in default-server: No
10473
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010474no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010475 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010476 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10477 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010478 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10479 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10480 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010481
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010482 Supported in default-server: No
10483
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010484no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010485 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010486 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10487 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010488 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10489 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10490 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010491
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010492 Supported in default-server: No
10493
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010494non-stick
10495 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10496 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10497 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10498
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010499 Supported in default-server: No
10500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010501observe <mode>
10502 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10503 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10504 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10505 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10506 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10507 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010508 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010510 Supported in default-server: No
10511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010512 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010514on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010515 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10516 Currently, four modes are available:
10517 - fastinter: force fastinter
10518 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10519 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10520 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10521 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010523 Supported in default-server: Yes
10524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010525 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10526
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010527on-marked-down <action>
10528 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10529 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010530 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10531 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10532 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10533 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10534 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10535 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10536 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10537 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010538
10539 Actions are disabled by default
10540
10541 Supported in default-server: Yes
10542
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010543on-marked-up <action>
10544 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10545 Currently one action is available:
10546 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10547 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10548 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10549 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10550 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10551 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10552 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10553 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10554
10555 Actions are disabled by default
10556
10557 Supported in default-server: Yes
10558
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010559port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010560 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10561 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10562 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10563 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10564 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10565 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010567 Supported in default-server: Yes
10568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010569redir <prefix>
10570 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10571 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10572 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10573 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10574 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10575 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10576 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10577 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010578 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010579 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10580 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10581 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10582 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10583 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10584
10585 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010587 Supported in default-server: No
10588
10589rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010590 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10591 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10592 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010594 Supported in default-server: Yes
10595
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010596resolve-prefer <family>
10597 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10598 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10599 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10600 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10601
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010602 Default value: ipv6
10603
10604 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010605
10606 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10607
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010608resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10609 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10610 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10611 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10612 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10613 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10614 configured network, another address is selected.
10615
10616 Supported in default-server: Yes
10617
10618 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10619
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010620resolvers <id>
10621 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10622 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010623 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10624 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10625 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10626 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010627
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010628 Supported in default-server: No
10629
10630 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010631
10632 See also chapter 5.3
10633
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010634send-proxy
10635 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10636 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10637 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10638 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10639 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10640 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10641 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10642 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10643 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010644 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10645 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10646 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10647 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10648 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010649
10650 Supported in default-server: No
10651
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010652send-proxy-v2
10653 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10654 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10655 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10656 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10657 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10658 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10659 option of the "bind" keyword.
10660
10661 Supported in default-server: No
10662
10663send-proxy-v2-ssl
10664 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10665 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10666 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10667 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10668 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10669 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10670 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10671 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10672
10673 Supported in default-server: No
10674
10675send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10676 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10677 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10678 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10679 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10680 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10681 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10682 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10683 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10684 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10685
10686 Supported in default-server: No
10687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010688slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010689 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10690 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10691 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10692 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10693 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10694 parameters :
10695
10696 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10697 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10698
10699 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10700 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10701 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10702 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10703
10704 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10705 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10706 seen as failed.
10707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010708 Supported in default-server: Yes
10709
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010710sni <expression>
10711 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10712 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10713 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10714 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10715 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10716
10717 Supported in default-server: no
10718
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010719source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010720source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010721source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010722 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10723 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10724 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10725 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10726
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010727 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10728 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10729 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10730 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10731 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10732 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10733 server.
10734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010735 Supported in default-server: No
10736
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010737ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010738 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10739 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10740 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10741 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10742 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10743 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010744 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010745
10746 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010747
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010748tcp-ut <delay>
10749 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10750 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10751 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10752 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10753 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10754 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10755 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10756 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10757 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10758 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10759 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10760 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10761 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010763track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010764 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10765 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10766 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10767 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010768 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010770 Supported in default-server: No
10771
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010772verify [none|required]
10773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010774 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10775 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10776 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10777 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010778 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10779 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10780 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010781
10782 Supported in default-server: No
10783
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010784verifyhost <hostname>
10785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10786 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10787 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10788 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10789 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10790 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10791
10792 Supported in default-server: No
10793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010794weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010795 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10796 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10797 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010798 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10799 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10800 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10801 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10802 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10803 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010805 Supported in default-server: Yes
10806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010807
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108085.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10809-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010810
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010811HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10812using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10813configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010814This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10815can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10816workload.
10817This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10818resolution at run time.
10819Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10820carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10821
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010822Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10823health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10824
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010825
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108265.3.1. Global overview
10827----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010828
10829As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10830different steps of the process life:
10831
10832 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10833 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10834 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10835
10836 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10837 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10838 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10839
10840A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10841 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10842 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10843 resolution to know this new IP.
10844
10845A few things important to notice:
10846 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10847 first valid response.
10848
10849 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10850 servers return an error.
10851
10852
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108535.3.2. The resolvers section
10854----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010855
10856This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10857HAProxy.
10858There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10859many name servers.
10860
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010861When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10862uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10863is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10864answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10865
10866When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10867used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10868
10869Two types of behavior can be applied:
10870 1. stop DNS resolution
10871 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10872 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10873 1. ANY query type
10874 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10875 server's parameter
10876 3. remaining family type
10877
10878HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10879 - invalid DNS response packet
10880 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10881 - NX domain
10882 - Query refused by server
10883 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10884
10885HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10886 - no Answer records in the response
10887 - DNS response truncated
10888 - Error in DNS response
10889 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10890 - name server timeout
10891
10892For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10893 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10894 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10895 applied;
10896 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10897 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
10898 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
10899 stops resolution.
10900
10901
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010902resolvers <resolvers id>
10903 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10904
10905A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10906
10907nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10908 DNS server description:
10909 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10910 <ip> : IP address of the server
10911 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10912
10913hold <status> <period>
10914 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10915 on last resolution <status>
10916 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10917 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10918 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10919 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10920
10921 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10922
10923 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10924 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10925 the healch check.
10926
10927resolve_retries <nb>
10928 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10929 giving up.
10930 Default value: 3
10931
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010932 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
10933 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
10934 type.
10935
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010936timeout <event> <time>
10937 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10938 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10939 events available are:
10940 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10941 been received.
10942 Default value: 1s
10943 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10944 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10945
10946Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10947
10948 resolvers mydns
10949 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10950 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10951 resolve_retries 3
10952 timeout retry 1s
10953 hold valid 10s
10954
10955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109566. HTTP header manipulation
10957---------------------------
10958
10959In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10960response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10961request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10962which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010963against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010965If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10966to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10967but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10968HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10969stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10970because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10971a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10972still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010974This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10975in section 4.2 :
10976
10977 - reqadd <string>
10978 - reqallow <search>
10979 - reqiallow <search>
10980 - reqdel <search>
10981 - reqidel <search>
10982 - reqdeny <search>
10983 - reqideny <search>
10984 - reqpass <search>
10985 - reqipass <search>
10986 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10987 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10988 - reqtarpit <search>
10989 - reqitarpit <search>
10990 - rspadd <string>
10991 - rspdel <search>
10992 - rspidel <search>
10993 - rspdeny <search>
10994 - rspideny <search>
10995 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10996 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10997
10998With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10999is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11000parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11001prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11002Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11003
11004 \t for a tab
11005 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11006 \n for a new line (LF)
11007 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11008 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11009 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11010 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11011 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11012
11013The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11014portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11015above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11016regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
110179 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11018is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11019
11020The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11021after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11022
11023Notes related to these keywords :
11024---------------------------------
11025 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11026 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11027 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11028
11029 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11030 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11031 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11032
11033 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11034 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11035 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11036 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11037 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11038
11039 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11040 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11041 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11042 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11043 useless headers before adding new ones.
11044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011045 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011046 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11047
11048 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11049 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11050 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11051
11052 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11053 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011054 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011055
11056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110577. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11058----------------------------------
11059
11060Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11061client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11062The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11063these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11064but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11065data called patterns.
11066
11067
110687.1. ACL basics
11069---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011070
11071The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11072content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11073from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11074simple :
11075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011076 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011077 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11079 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011081The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11082adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011083
11084In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011086 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011087
11088This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11089Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11090and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011091an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11092conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11093as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11094are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011095
11096ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11097'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11098which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11099
11100There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11101performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11104specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11105this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011106methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11107ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108
11109Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11110 - boolean
11111 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11112 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11113 - string
11114 - data block
11115
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011116Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11117converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11118would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11119The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11120which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11121
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011122Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11123keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11124fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11125which are summarized in the table below :
11126
11127 +---------------------+-----------------+
11128 | Sample or converter | Default |
11129 | output type | matching method |
11130 +---------------------+-----------------+
11131 | boolean | bool |
11132 +---------------------+-----------------+
11133 | integer | int |
11134 +---------------------+-----------------+
11135 | ip | ip |
11136 +---------------------+-----------------+
11137 | string | str |
11138 +---------------------+-----------------+
11139 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11140 +---------------------+-----------------+
11141
11142Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11143matching method, see below.
11144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011145The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11146 - boolean
11147 - integer or integer range
11148 - IP address / network
11149 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11150 - regular expression
11151 - hex block
11152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11154
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011155 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11156 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011157 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011158 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011159 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011160 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011161 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11164read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11165if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11166lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11167will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11168beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11169a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11170lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11171exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11172
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011173The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11174parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11175ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11176a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11177check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11178
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011179The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11180socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11181file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011183Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11184loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11185
11186 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11187
11188In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11189the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11190case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11191as well.
11192
11193The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11194sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11195do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11196methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11197is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11198obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11199followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11200default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11201that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11202string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11203
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011204The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11205By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11206string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11207resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11208server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11209waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11210flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11211function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011213There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11214sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11215be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011216
11217 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11218 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011219 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11220 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11221 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11222 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011223
11224 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11225 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011226 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011227
11228 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011229 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011230
11231 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011232 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011233
11234 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11235 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11236
11237 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11238 binary or string samples.
11239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011240 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11241 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011243 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11244 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11245 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011247 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11248 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011250 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11251 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011253 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11254 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011256 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11257 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011258 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011260 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11261 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11262 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011263
11264For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11265request, it is possible to do :
11266
11267 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11268
11269In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11270buffer, one would use the following acl :
11271
11272 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11273
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011274On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11275possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11276
11277 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011279All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11280criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11281method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11282to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11283criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11284the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011286If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011287the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11288For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11291 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11292 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11293 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011294
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011295
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011296The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11297types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11298combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11299brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11300default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302 +-------------------------------------------------+
11303 | Input sample type |
11304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011305 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11307 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011309 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011311 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011313 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011315 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011317 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011319 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011321 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011323 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011325 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011327 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011329 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11331 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11332 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011333
11334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113357.1.1. Matching booleans
11336------------------------
11337
11338In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11339Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11340When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11341that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11342
11343Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11344return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11345"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113487.1.2. Matching integers
11349------------------------
11350
11351Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11352enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11353to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11354
11355Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11356matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11357lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011358
11359For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11360unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11361representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11362
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011363As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11364two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11365instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11366ranges and operators.
11367
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011368For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011369operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11370Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11371of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011373Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011374
11375 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11376 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11377 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11378 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11379 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011381For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011382
11383 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11384
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011385This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11386
11387 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11388
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113907.1.3. Matching strings
11391-----------------------
11392
11393String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11394different forms :
11395
11396 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11397 patterns ;
11398
11399 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11400 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11401
11402 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11403 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11404
11405 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11406 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11407
11408 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11409 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11410 matches.
11411
11412 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11413 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11414 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011415
11416String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11417exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11418characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11419string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11420to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011421before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011422
11423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114247.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11425---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011426
11427Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11428they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11429possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11430passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11431the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011432the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11433match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011434
11435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114367.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11437-------------------------------------
11438
11439It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11440not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11441a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11442to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11443digits may be used upper or lower case.
11444
11445Example :
11446 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11447 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11448
11449
114507.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11451---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011452
11453IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11454netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11455within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011456host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011457difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11458at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11459does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11460parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011461
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011462IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11463Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11464trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11465IPv6 patterns.
11466
11467HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11468following situations :
11469 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11470 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11471 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11472 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11473 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11474 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11475 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11476 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11477 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11478 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480
114817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11482----------------------------------
11483
11484Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11485combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11486
11487 - AND (implicit)
11488 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11489 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011491A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011495Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11496indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11499"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11500requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11501is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11502
11503 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11504 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11505 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11506 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11507
11508To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11509and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11510
11511 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11512 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11513 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11514 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11515
11516 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11517 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11518 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11519 use_backend www if host_www
11520
11521It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11522expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11523be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11524the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11525
11526 The following rule :
11527
11528 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11529 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11530
11531 Can also be written that way :
11532
11533 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11534
11535It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11536to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11537simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11538sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11539good use is the following :
11540
11541 With named ACLs :
11542
11543 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11544 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11545 monitor fail if site_dead
11546
11547 With anonymous ACLs :
11548
11549 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11550
11551See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11552
11553
115547.3. Fetching samples
11555---------------------
11556
11557Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11558against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11559sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11560ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11561of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11562available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11563
11564This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11565Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11566compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11567deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11568
11569The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11570matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11571method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11572indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11573
11574As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11575when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11576mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11577the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11578ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11579
11580Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11581multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11582when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11583incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11584are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11585is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11586all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11587
11588Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11589 - name
11590 - name(arg1)
11591 - name(arg1,arg2)
11592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011593
115947.3.1. Converters
11595-----------------
11596
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011597Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11598of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11599is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11600was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11601has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11602unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11603
11604These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11605sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11606the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11607support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011608
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011609A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11610support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11611supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11612(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11613bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011615The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011616
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011617add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011618 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011619 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11620 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11621 allowed scopes are:
11622 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11623 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11624 response),
11625 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11626 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11627 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11628 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011629
11630and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011631 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011632 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11633 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11634 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11635 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11636 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11637 response),
11638 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11639 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11640 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11641 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011642
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011643base64
11644 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11645 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11646 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11647
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011648bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011649 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011650 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11651 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11652 presence of a flag).
11653
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011654bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11655 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11656 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11657 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11658
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011659cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011660 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11661 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011662
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011663crc32([<avalanche>])
11664 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11665 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11666 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11667 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11668 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11669 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11670 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11671 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11672 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11673 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11674 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11675
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011676da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011677 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11678 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11679 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11680 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11681 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11682 configuration language.
11683
11684 Example:
11685 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011686 bind *:8881
11687 default_backend servers
11688 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011689
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011690debug
11691 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11692 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11693 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11694
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011695div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011696 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11697 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011698 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11699 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11700 scope. The scope allowed are:
11701 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11702 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11703 response),
11704 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11705 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11706 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11707 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011708
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011709djb2([<avalanche>])
11710 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11711 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11712 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11713 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11714 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11715 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11716 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011717 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11718 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011719
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011720even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011721 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011722 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11723
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011724field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11725 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11726 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11727 list of chars.
11728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011729hex
11730 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11731 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11732 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11733 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011734
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011735http_date([<offset>])
11736 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11737 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11738 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11739 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11740 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11741 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011742
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011743in_table(<table>)
11744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11746 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11747 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11748 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11749
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011750ipmask(<mask>)
11751 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11752 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11753 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11754 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11755
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011756json([<input-code>])
11757 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11758 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11759 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11760 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11761 of errors:
11762 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11763 bytes, ...)
11764 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11765 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11766
11767 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11768 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11769 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11770 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11771 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11772 are :
11773 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11774 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11775 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11776 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11777 error ;
11778 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11779 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11780
11781 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11782 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11783
11784 Example:
11785 capture request header user-agent len 150
11786 capture request header Host len 15
11787 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11788
11789 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11790 GET / HTTP/1.0
11791 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11792
11793 Output log:
11794 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11795
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011796language(<value>[,<default>])
11797 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11798 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11799 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11800 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11801 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11802 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11803 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11804 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11805 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11806 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11807 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11808 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011809
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011810 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011812 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11813 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011814
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011815 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11816 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11817 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11818 use_backend spanish if es
11819 use_backend french if fr
11820 use_backend english if en
11821 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011822
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011823lower
11824 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11825 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11826 type. The result is of type string.
11827
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011828ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11829 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11830 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11831 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11832 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11833 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11834 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11835
11836 Example :
11837
11838 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11839 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11840 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11841
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011842map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11843map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11844map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11845 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11846 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11847 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11848 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11849 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11850 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11851 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11852 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011854 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11855 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11856 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011857
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011858 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11859 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011860
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011861 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11862 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11863 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11864 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011865 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11866 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011867 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11868 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11869 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11870 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11871 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11872 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11873 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11874 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011875 | | map_reg | |
11876 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11877 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011878 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11879 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11880 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11881 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11882 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011883
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011884 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
11885 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
11886 the corresponding match text.
11887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011888 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11889 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11890 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11891 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11892 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011894 Example :
11895
11896 # this is a comment and is ignored
11897 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11898 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11899 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11900 | | | `---------- value
11901 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11902 | `---------------------------- key
11903 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11904
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011905mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011906 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11907 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011908 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11909 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11910 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11911 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11912 response),
11913 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11914 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11915 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11916 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011917
11918mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011919 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011920 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11921 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011922 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11923 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11924 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11925 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11926 response),
11927 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11928 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11930 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011931
11932neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011933 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11934 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11935 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11936 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011937
11938not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011939 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011940 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11941 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11942 absence of a flag).
11943
11944odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011945 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011946 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11947
11948or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011949 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011950 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11951 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11952 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11953 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11954 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11955 response),
11956 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11957 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11959 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011960
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011961regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011962 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11963 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11964 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11965 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11966 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11967 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11968 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11969 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11970 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11971 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11972 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11973 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11974 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11975
11976 Example :
11977
11978 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11979 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11980 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11981 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11982
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011983capture-req(<id>)
11984 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11985 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11986
11987 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020011988 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
11989 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011990
11991capture-res(<id>)
11992 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11993 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11994
11995 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020011996 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
11997 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011998
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011999sdbm([<avalanche>])
12000 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12001 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12002 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12003 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12004 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12005 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12006 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012007 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12008 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012009
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012010set-var(<var name>)
12011 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
12012 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12013 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
12014 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12015 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12016 response),
12017 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12018 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12019 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12020 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12021
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012022sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012023 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12024 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012025 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
12026 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
12027 scope. The allowed scopes are:
12028 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12029 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12030 response),
12031 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12032 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12033 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12034 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012035
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012036table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12040 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12041 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12042 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12043
12044
12045table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12049 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12050 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12051 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12052
12053table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12057 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12058 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12059
12060table_conn_cur(<table>)
12061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12063 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12064 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12065 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12066
12067table_conn_rate(<table>)
12068 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12069 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12070 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12071 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12072 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12073
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012074table_gpt0(<table>)
12075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12078 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12079 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12080
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012081table_gpc0(<table>)
12082 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12083 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12084 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12085 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12086 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12087
12088table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12089 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12090 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12091 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12092 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12093 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12094 sample fetch keyword.
12095
12096table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12097 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12098 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12099 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12100 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12101 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12102
12103table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12104 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12105 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12106 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12107 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12108 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12109 keyword.
12110
12111table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12112 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12113 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12114 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12115 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12116 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12117
12118table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12119 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12120 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12121 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12122 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12123 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12124 keyword.
12125
12126table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12130 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12131 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12132 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12133 keyword.
12134
12135table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12139 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12140 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12141 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12142 keyword.
12143
12144table_server_id(<table>)
12145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12147 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12148 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12149 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12150 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12151
12152table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12155 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12156 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12157 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12158 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12159 keyword.
12160
12161table_sess_rate(<table>)
12162 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12163 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12164 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12165 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12166 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12167 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12168 keyword.
12169
12170table_trackers(<table>)
12171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12174 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12175 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12176 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12177 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12178 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12179 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12180 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12181
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012182upper
12183 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12184 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12185 type. The result is of type string.
12186
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012187url_dec
12188 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12189 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12190
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012191utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12192 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12193 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12194 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12195 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12196 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12197 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12198
12199 Example :
12200
12201 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12202 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12203 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12204
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012205word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12206 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12207 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12208
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012209wt6([<avalanche>])
12210 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12211 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12212 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12213 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12214 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12215 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12216 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012217 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12218 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012219
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012220xor(<value>)
12221 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012222 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012223 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
12224 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
12225 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12226 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12227 response),
12228 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12229 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12230 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12231 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012232
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122347.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235--------------------------------------------
12236
12237A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12238not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12239"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12240The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12241
12242always_false : boolean
12243 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12244 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12245
12246always_true : boolean
12247 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12248 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12249
12250avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012251 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12253 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12254 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12255 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12256 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12257 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12258 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12259 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12260 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12261 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12262 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12263 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12264 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012267 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12268 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12269 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12270 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12271 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012273be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12275 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12276 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12277 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12278 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12279 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012280
12281 Example :
12282 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12283 backend dynamic
12284 mode http
12285 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12286 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012287
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012288bin(<hexa>) : bin
12289 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12290 of the string.
12291
12292bool(<bool>) : bool
12293 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12294 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012296connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12297 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012298 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012299 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12300 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012301
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012302 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012303 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012304 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12305
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012306 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12307 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012308
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012309 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012310 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012311 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012312 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12313 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012315 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012316
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012317 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12318 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012319 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012320 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012321
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012322date([<offset>]) : integer
12323 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12324 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12325 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12326 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012327 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12328
12329 Example :
12330
12331 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12332 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012333
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012334env(<name>) : string
12335 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12336 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12337 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12338 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12339 certain way.
12340
12341 Examples :
12342 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12343 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12344
12345 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12346 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12349 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012350 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12351 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012352 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12353 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12354 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12355 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12356 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012358fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12360 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12361 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12362 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12363 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12364 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12365 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12366 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012367
12368 Example :
12369 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12370 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12371 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12372 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12373 frontend mail
12374 bind :25
12375 mode tcp
12376 maxconn 100
12377 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12378 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12379 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12380 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012381
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012382int(<integer>) : signed integer
12383 Returns a signed integer.
12384
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012385ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12386 Returns an ipv4.
12387
12388ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12389 Returns an ipv6.
12390
12391meth(<method>) : method
12392 Returns a method.
12393
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012394nbproc : integer
12395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12396 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12397 and debugging purposes.
12398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012399nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12400 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12401 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12402 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012403 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12404 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12405 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012406
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012407proc : integer
12408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12409 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12410 debugging purposes.
12411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012412queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012413 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12414 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12415 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012416 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12417 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12418 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12419 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12420 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12421
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012422rand([<range>]) : integer
12423 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12424 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12425 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12426 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12427 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012429srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12431 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12432 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12433 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12434 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12435 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12436 methods.
12437
12438srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12439 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12440 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12441 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12442 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12443 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12444 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12445 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12446
12447srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12448 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12449 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012450 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12452 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12453 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12454 overloading servers).
12455
12456 Example :
12457 # Redirect to a separate back
12458 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12459 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12460 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12461
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012462stopping : boolean
12463 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12464 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12465 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12466
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012467str(<string>) : string
12468 Returns a string.
12469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012470table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12471 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12472 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12473
12474table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12475 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12476 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12477 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12478
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012479var(<var-name>) : undefined
12480 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
12481 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
12482 scope. The scope allowed are:
12483 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12484 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12485 response),
12486 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12487 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12488 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12489 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124927.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012493----------------------------------
12494
12495The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12496closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12497methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12498sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12499TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012500the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12501counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12502"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012503argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12504the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12505this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012506
12507be_id : integer
12508 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12509 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12510
12511dst : ip
12512 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12513 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12514 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12515 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12516 RFC 4291.
12517
12518dst_conn : integer
12519 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12520 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12521 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12522 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12523 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12524 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12525 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12526 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528dst_port : integer
12529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12530 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12531 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12532 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12533 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12534 an HTTP header.
12535
12536fe_id : integer
12537 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12538 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12539 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012541sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012542sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12543sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12544sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012545 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12546 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12547 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012549sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012550sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12551sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12552sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012553 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12554 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12555 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012557sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012558sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12559sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12560sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012561 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12562 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012563 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12564 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12565 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012566
12567 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12568 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012569 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12570 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12571 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012572 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12573 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12574
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012575sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012576sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12577sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12578sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012579 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12580 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12581
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012582sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012583sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12584sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12585sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012586 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12587 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12588 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012590sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012591sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12592sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12593sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012594 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12595 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12596 See also src_conn_rate.
12597
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012598sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012599sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12600sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12601sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012602 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012603 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012604
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012605sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12606sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12607sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12608sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12609 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12610 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12611
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012612sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012613sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12614sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12615sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012616 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12617 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12618 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012619 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12620 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12621 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012623sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012624sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12625sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12626sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012627 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12628 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12629 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012631sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012632sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12633sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12634sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012635 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12636 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12637 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12638 src_http_err_rate.
12639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012640sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012641sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12642sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12643sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012644 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12645 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12646 src_http_req_cnt.
12647
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012648sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012649sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12650sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12651sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012652 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12653 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12654 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12655 src_http_req_rate.
12656
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012657sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012658sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12659sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12660sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012661 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012662 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12663 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12664 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12665 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012666
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012667 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12668 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012669 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12670
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012671sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012672sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12673sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12674sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012675 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12676 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12677 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012678
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012679sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012680sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12681sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12682sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012683 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12684 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12685 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012686
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012687sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012688sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12689sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12690sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012691 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12692 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12693 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12694 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012695 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012696 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12697
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012698sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012699sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12700sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12701sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012702 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12703 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12704 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12705 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12706 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012707 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012709sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012710sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12711sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12712sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012713 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12714 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12715 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012717sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012718sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12719sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12720sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012721 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12722 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012723 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012724 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12725 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12727 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12728 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730so_id : integer
12731 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12732 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12733 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735src : ip
12736 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12737 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12738 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12739 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12740 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12741 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12742 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012743
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012744 Example:
12745 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12746 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12749 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12750 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12751 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012752 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12755 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12756 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012757 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012758 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12761 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12762 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12763 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12764 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12765 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12766 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012767
12768 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12769 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12770 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12771 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012772 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012773 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12774 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012776src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012777 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012779 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012780 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012782src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012783 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012784 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12785 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012786 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012788src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12789 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12790 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12791 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012792 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012795 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012796 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012797 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012798 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012799
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012800src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12801 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12802 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12803 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12804 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012806src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012807 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012808 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012809 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12810 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012811 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12812 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12813 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12816 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12817 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012818 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012819 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012820 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12823 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12824 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12825 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12826 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012827 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12830 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12831 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12832 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012833 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12836 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12837 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12838 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012839 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012840 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012842src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12843 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12844 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12845 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012846 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12848 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012849
12850 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012851 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012852 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012854src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012855 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12856 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12857 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12858 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12859 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012862 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12863 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12864 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12865 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12866 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868src_port : integer
12869 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12870 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12871 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12872 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012874src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12875 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012876 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12877 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12878 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012879 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12882 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12883 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12884 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12885 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012886 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12889 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12890 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12891 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12892 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12893 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12894 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12895 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12896 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012897
12898 Example :
12899 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12900 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12901 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12902 listen ssh
12903 bind :22
12904 mode tcp
12905 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012906 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012907 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012908 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012910srv_id : integer
12911 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12912 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12913 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012914
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129167.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012919The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12920closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12921when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12922usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012923future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012924
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012925ssl_bc : boolean
12926 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12927 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12928 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12929
12930ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12931 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12932 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12933
12934ssl_bc_cipher : string
12935 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12936 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12937
12938ssl_bc_protocol : string
12939 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12940 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12941
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012942ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012943 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012944 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12945 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012946
12947ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12948 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12949 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12950 if session was reused or not.
12951
12952ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12953 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12954 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12957 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12958 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12959 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12960 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12961 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12964 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12965 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12966 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12967 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012968
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012969ssl_c_der : binary
12970 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12971 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12972 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974ssl_c_err : integer
12975 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12976 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12977 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12978 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12979 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012981ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12982 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12983 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12984 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12985 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12986 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12987 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12988 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12989 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012991ssl_c_key_alg : string
12992 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12993 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12994 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996ssl_c_notafter : string
12997 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12998 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12999 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001ssl_c_notbefore : string
13002 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13003 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13004 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13007 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13008 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13009 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13010 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13011 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13012 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13013 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13014 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016ssl_c_serial : binary
13017 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13018 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13019 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13022 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13023 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13024 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013025 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13026 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13027
13028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13031 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13032 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13033 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013035ssl_c_used : boolean
13036 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13037 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039ssl_c_verify : integer
13040 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13041 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13042 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13043 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013045ssl_c_version : integer
13046 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13047 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013048
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013049ssl_f_der : binary
13050 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13051 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13052 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013054ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13055 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13056 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13057 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13058 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013059 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13061 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13062 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064ssl_f_key_alg : string
13065 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13066 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13067 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013069ssl_f_notafter : string
13070 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13071 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13072 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013074ssl_f_notbefore : string
13075 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13076 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13077 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13080 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13081 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13082 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13083 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13084 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13085 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13086 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13087 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013089ssl_f_serial : binary
13090 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13091 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13092 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013093
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013094ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13095 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13096 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13097 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13100 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13101 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13102 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104ssl_f_version : integer
13105 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13106 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13107
13108ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013109 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13110 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13111 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113 Example :
13114 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13115 listen http-https
13116 bind :80
13117 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13118 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13119
13120ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13121 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13122 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13123
13124ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013125 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13127 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13128 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13129 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13130 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13131 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13132 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13133 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135ssl_fc_cipher : string
13136 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13137 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013140 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13141 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013142 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13143 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13144 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13145 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13148 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013149 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13150 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13151 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13152 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013153
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013154ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
13155 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13156 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013159 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13161 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13162 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13163 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13164 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13165 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13166 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168ssl_fc_protocol : string
13169 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13170 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013171
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013172ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013173 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013174 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13175 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13178 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13179 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13180 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13181 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013183ssl_fc_sni : string
13184 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13185 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13186 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13187 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13188 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13189
13190 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13191 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13192 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013193 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13194 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013196 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13198 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13201 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13202 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013203
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132057.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13209sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13210only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13211For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13212be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13213can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13214sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13215for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13216content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13219 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13220 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13221 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13224 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13225 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13226 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013228req.len : integer
13229req_len : integer (deprecated)
13230 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13231 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13232 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13233 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13234 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13235 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13236 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13237 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13240 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013241 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13242 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13243 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13244 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246 ACL alternatives :
13247 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13250 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13251 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13252 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13253 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013255 ACL alternatives :
13256 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013260req.proto_http : boolean
13261req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13262 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13263 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13264 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13265 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13266 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13267 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13268 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270 Example:
13271 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13272 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13273 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013274 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13277rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13278 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13279 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13280 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13281 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13282 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13283 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13284 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13287 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13288 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13289 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13290 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13291 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 ACL derivatives :
13294 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296 Example :
13297 listen tse-farm
13298 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13299 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13300 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13301 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13302 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13303 persist rdp-cookie
13304 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13305 # This is only useful makes sense if
13306 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13307 stick-table type string size 204800
13308 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13309 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13310 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013312 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13313 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013315req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13316rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13317 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13318 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13319 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13320 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322 ACL derivatives :
13323 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013324
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013325req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13326 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13327 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013328 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13329 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13330 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13331 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13332 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13335req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13336 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13337 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13338 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13339 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13340 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13341 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13342 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344req.ssl_sni : string
13345req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13346 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13347 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13348 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13349 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13350 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13351 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13352 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13353 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13354 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13355 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13356 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13357 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359 ACL derivatives :
13360 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 Examples :
13363 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13364 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13365 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13366 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13367 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013368
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013369req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13370 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13371 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13372 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13373 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13374 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13375 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13376 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13377 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13378 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380req.ssl_ver : integer
13381req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13382 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13383 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13384 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13385 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13386 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13387 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13388 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13389 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13390 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392 ACL derivatives :
13393 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013394
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013395res.len : integer
13396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13397 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13398 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13399 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13400 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13401 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13402 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13403 content inspection.
13404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13406 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013407 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13408 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13409 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13410 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013412res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13413 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13414 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13415 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13416 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013418 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013419
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013420res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13421rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13422 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13423 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13424 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13425 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13426 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13427 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13428 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430wait_end : boolean
13431 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13432 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13433 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13434 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13435 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13436 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13437 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13438 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440 Examples :
13441 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13442 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13443 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13446 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13447 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13448 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13449 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13450 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13451 tcp-request content reject
13452
13453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134547.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455--------------------------------------
13456
13457It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13458This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13459data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13460its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13461HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13462content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13463to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13464more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13465response are indexed.
13466
13467base : string
13468 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13469 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13470 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13471 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13472 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13473 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13474 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13475 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13476
13477 ACL derivatives :
13478 base : exact string match
13479 base_beg : prefix match
13480 base_dir : subdir match
13481 base_dom : domain match
13482 base_end : suffix match
13483 base_len : length match
13484 base_reg : regex match
13485 base_sub : substring match
13486
13487base32 : integer
13488 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13489 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13490 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013491 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13492 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13493 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013494
13495base32+src : binary
13496 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13497 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13498 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13499 per-URL counters.
13500
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013501capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13502 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13503 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13504 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13505
13506capture.req.method : string
13507 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13508 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13509 because it's allocated.
13510
13511capture.req.uri : string
13512 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13513 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13514 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13515 allocated.
13516
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013517capture.req.ver : string
13518 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13519 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13520 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13521
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013522capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13523 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13524 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13525 The first entry is an index of 0.
13526 See also: "capture response header"
13527
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013528capture.res.ver : string
13529 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13530 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13531 persistent flag.
13532
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013533req.body : binary
13534 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13535 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13536 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13537 the first chunk is analyzed.
13538
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013539req.body_param([<name>) : string
13540 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13541 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13542 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13543 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13544 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13545 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13546 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13547 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13548 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13549 given.
13550
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013551req.body_len : integer
13552 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13553 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13554 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13555 "option http-buffer-request".
13556
13557req.body_size : integer
13558 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13559 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13560 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13561 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13562 "option http-buffer-request".
13563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013564req.cook([<name>]) : string
13565cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13566 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13567 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13568 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13569 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13570 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13571 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13572 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13573 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13574
13575 ACL derivatives :
13576 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13577 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13578 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13579 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13580 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13581 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13582 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13583 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13586cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13587 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13588 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13591cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13592 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13593 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13594 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13595 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013597cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13598 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13599 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13600 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13601 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013602 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13604 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13605 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13606 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013608hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13609 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13610 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13611 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13612 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013613 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013615req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13616 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13617 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13618 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13619 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13620 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13621 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13622 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13623 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13626 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13627 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13628 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13629 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013631req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13632 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13633 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13634 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13635 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13636 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13637 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13638 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13639 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13640 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13641 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13642 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644 ACL derivatives :
13645 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13646 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13647 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13648 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13649 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13650 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13651 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13652 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13653
13654req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13655hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13656 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13657 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13658 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13659 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13660 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13661 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13662 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13663 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13664 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13665
13666req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13667hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13668 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13669 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13670 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13671 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13672 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13673 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13674 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13675 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13676
13677req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13678hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13679 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13680 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13681 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13682 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13683 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13684 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13685 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13686
13687http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13688 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13689 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13690 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13691 basic auth is supported.
13692
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013693http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13694 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13695 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13696 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13697 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13699 basic auth is supported.
13700
13701 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013702 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13703 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13704 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13705 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706
13707http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013708 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13709 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013710 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13711 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713method : integer + string
13714 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13715 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13716 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13717 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13718 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13719 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13720 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013722 ACL derivatives :
13723 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725 Example :
13726 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13727 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13728 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730path : string
13731 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13732 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13733 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13734 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13735 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13736 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13737 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013739 ACL derivatives :
13740 path : exact string match
13741 path_beg : prefix match
13742 path_dir : subdir match
13743 path_dom : domain match
13744 path_end : suffix match
13745 path_len : length match
13746 path_reg : regex match
13747 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013748
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013749query : string
13750 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13751 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13752 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13753 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13754 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13755 which stops before the question mark.
13756
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013757req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13758 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13759 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13760 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13761 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763req.ver : string
13764req_ver : string (deprecated)
13765 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13766 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13767 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013769 ACL derivatives :
13770 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772res.comp : boolean
13773 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13774 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13775 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777res.comp_algo : string
13778 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13779 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13780 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782res.cook([<name>]) : string
13783scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13784 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13785 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13786 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788 ACL derivatives :
13789 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13792scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13793 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13794 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13795 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13798scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13799 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13800 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13801 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013803res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13804 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13805 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13806 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13807 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13808 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13809 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13810 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13811 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13812 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013814res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13815 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13816 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13817 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13818 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13819 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13822shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13823 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13824 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13825 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13826 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13827 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13828 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13829 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13830 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013832 ACL derivatives :
13833 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13834 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13835 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13836 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13837 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13838 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13839 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13840 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13841
13842res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13843shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13844 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13845 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13846 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13847 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13848 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13851shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13852 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13853 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13854 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13855 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13856 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13857 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013858
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013859res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13860 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13861 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13862 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13863 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013865res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13866shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13867 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13868 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13869 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13870 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13871 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13872 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874res.ver : string
13875resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13876 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13877 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013879 ACL derivatives :
13880 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13883 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13884 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013885 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13889 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013891status : integer
13892 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13893 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13894 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896url : string
13897 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13898 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13899 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13900 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13901 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13902 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13903 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905 ACL derivatives :
13906 url : exact string match
13907 url_beg : prefix match
13908 url_dir : subdir match
13909 url_dom : domain match
13910 url_end : suffix match
13911 url_len : length match
13912 url_reg : regex match
13913 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915url_ip : ip
13916 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13917 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13918 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13919 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13920 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13921 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13922 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013924url_port : integer
13925 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13926 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13927 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13928 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013929
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013930urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13931url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13933 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013934 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13935 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13936 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13937 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013938 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13939 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013940 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13941 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943 ACL derivatives :
13944 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13945 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13946 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13947 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13948 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13949 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13950 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13951 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013952
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954 Example :
13955 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13956 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13957 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13958 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013959
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013960urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13962 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13963 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013964
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139667.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013967---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013969Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13970every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013971order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013973ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13974---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013975FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013976HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013977HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13978HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013979HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13980HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13981HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13982HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13983LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013984METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13985METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13986METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13987METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13988METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13989METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013990RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013991REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013992TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013993WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13994---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013995
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139978. Logging
13998----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014000One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14001provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14002very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14003provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14004state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014005to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014006headers.
14007
14008In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14009about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14010send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14011
14012 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14013 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14014 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14015 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14016 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014017 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14018 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014019
14020The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14021allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14022as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14023while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14024real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14025delay.
14026
14027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140288.1. Log levels
14029---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014030
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014031TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014032source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014033HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14034in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14035track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14036syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14037about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014038
14039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140408.2. Log formats
14041----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014042
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014043HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014044and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14045slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14046options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014047
14048 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14049 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14050 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14051 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14052 extents.
14053
14054 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14055 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14056 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14057 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14058 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14059
14060 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14061 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14062 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14063 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14064 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14065
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014066 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14067 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14068 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14069 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14070
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014071 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14072
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014073Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14074specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14075field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14076servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14077always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14078identifier.
14079
14080Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14081 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14082 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14083 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14084 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14085
14086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140878.2.1. Default log format
14088-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014089
14090This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14091as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14092format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14093
14094 Example :
14095 listen www
14096 mode http
14097 log global
14098 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14099
14100 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14101 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14102 (www/HTTP)
14103
14104 Field Format Extract from the example above
14105 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14106 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14107 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14108 4 'to' to
14109 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14110 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14111
14112Detailed fields description :
14113 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14114 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14115 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14116 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14117 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14118 and processed the connection.
14119 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14120
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014121In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14122"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14123connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14124
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014125It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14126will eventually disappear.
14127
14128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141298.2.2. TCP log format
14130---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014131
14132The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14133is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14134information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14135counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14136emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14137environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14138the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14139sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014140specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14141not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14142fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14143marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014144
14145 Example :
14146 frontend fnt
14147 mode tcp
14148 option tcplog
14149 log global
14150 default_backend bck
14151
14152 backend bck
14153 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14154
14155 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14156 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14157 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14158
14159 Field Format Extract from the example above
14160 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14161 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14162 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14163 4 frontend_name fnt
14164 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14165 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14166 7 bytes_read* 212
14167 8 termination_state --
14168 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14169 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14170
14171Detailed fields description :
14172 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014173 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14174 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14175 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14176 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14177 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014178
14179 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014180 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14181 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14182 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014183
14184 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14185 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14186 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14187 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14188
14189 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14190 and processed the connection.
14191
14192 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14193 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14194 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14195 applications.
14196
14197 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14198 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14199 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14200 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14201 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14202
14203 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14204 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14205 See "Timers" below for more details.
14206
14207 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14208 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14209 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14210 "Timers" below for more details.
14211
14212 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014213 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014214 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14215 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14216 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14217 details.
14218
14219 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14220 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14221 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14222 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14223 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14224
14225 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14226 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14227 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14228 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14229 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14230 for more details.
14231
14232 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014233 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014234 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14235 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14236 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014237 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014238
14239 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14240 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14241 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14242 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14243 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14244 caused by a denial of service attack.
14245
14246 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14247 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14248 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14249 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14250 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14251 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14252 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14253 denial of service attack.
14254
14255 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14256 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14257 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14258 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14259 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14260 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14261 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14262 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14263 be processed than on other servers.
14264
14265 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14266 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14267 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14268 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14269 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14270 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14271 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14272 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14273 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14274 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14275 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14276 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14277 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14278
14279 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14280 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14281 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14282 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14283 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14284 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14285 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14286 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14287
14288 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14289 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14290 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14291 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14292 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14293 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14294 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14295 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14296 occurs.
14297
14298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142998.2.3. HTTP log format
14300----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014301
14302The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14303is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14304the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14305are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14306emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14307generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14308"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14309which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014310frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14311is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014312
14313Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14314slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14315with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14316
14317 Example :
14318 frontend http-in
14319 mode http
14320 option httplog
14321 log global
14322 default_backend bck
14323
14324 backend static
14325 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14326
14327 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14328 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14329 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014330 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014331
14332 Field Format Extract from the example above
14333 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14334 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14335 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14336 4 frontend_name http-in
14337 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14338 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14339 7 status_code 200
14340 8 bytes_read* 2750
14341 9 captured_request_cookie -
14342 10 captured_response_cookie -
14343 11 termination_state ----
14344 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14345 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14346 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14347 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14348 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014349
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014350
14351Detailed fields description :
14352 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014353 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14354 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14355 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14356 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14357 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014358
14359 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014360 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14361 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14362 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014363
14364 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14365 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14366 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14367 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14368 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14369
14370 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14371 and processed the connection.
14372
14373 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14374 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14375 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14376
14377 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14378 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14379 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14380 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14381 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14382 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14383
14384 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14385 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14386 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14387 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14388 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14389 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14390
14391 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14392 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14393 See "Timers" below for more details.
14394
14395 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14396 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14397 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14398 below for more details.
14399
14400 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14401 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14402 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14403 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14404 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14405 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14406 for more details.
14407
14408 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014409 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014410 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14411 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14412 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14413 details.
14414
14415 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14416 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14417 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14418
14419 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14420 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14421 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14422 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14423 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14424 overflowing.
14425
14426 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14427 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14428 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14429 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14430 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14431 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14432 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14433 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14434
14435 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14436 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14437 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14438 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14439 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14440 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14441 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14442 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14443
14444 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14445 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14446 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14447 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14448 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14449 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14450 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14451
14452 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014453 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014454 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14455 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14456 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014457 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014458 system.
14459
14460 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14461 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14462 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14463 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14464 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14465 caused by a denial of service attack.
14466
14467 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14468 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14469 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14470 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14471 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14472 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14473 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14474 denial of service attack.
14475
14476 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14477 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14478 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14479 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14480 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14481 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14482 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14483 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14484 processed than on other servers.
14485
14486 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14487 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14488 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14489 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14490 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14491 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14492 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14493 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14494 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14495 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14496 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14497 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14498 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14499
14500 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14501 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14502 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14503 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14504 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14505 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14506 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14507 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14508
14509 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14510 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14511 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14512 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14513 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14514 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14515 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14516 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14517 occurs.
14518
14519 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14520 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14521 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14522 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14523 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14524 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14525 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14526 cookies" below for more details.
14527
14528 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14529 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14530 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14531 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14532 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14533 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14534 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14535 and cookies" below for more details.
14536
14537 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14538 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14539 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14540 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14541 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14542 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14543 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14544 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14545
14546
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200145478.2.4. Custom log format
14548------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014549
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014550The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014551mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014552
14553HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14554Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14555separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14556prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14557
14558Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14559variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014560("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014561
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014562If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014563as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014564less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14565the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14566
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014567Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014568In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014569in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014570
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014571Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14572'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14573https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14574such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14575
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014576Flags are :
14577 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014578 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014579 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14580 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014581
14582 Example:
14583
14584 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14585 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14586
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014587 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14588
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014589At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14590
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014591 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14592 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014593
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014594the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014595
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014596 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014597 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014598 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014599
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014600and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14601
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014602 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014603 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14604
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014605Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14606
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014607 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014608 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014609 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14610 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14611 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014612 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14613 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14614 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014615 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014616 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14617 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014618 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014619 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14620 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014621 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014622 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014623 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014624 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014625 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014626 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14627 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014628 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014629 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14630 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014631 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014632 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14633 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014634 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14635 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14636 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014637 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014638 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14639 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014640 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014641 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14642 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14643 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014644 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014645 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014646 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14647 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14648 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14649 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014650 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014651 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014652 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014653 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014654 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014655 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014656 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14657 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14658 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014659 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014660 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14661 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014662 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014663 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014664 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014665 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014666
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014667 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014668
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014669
146708.2.5. Error log format
14671-----------------------
14672
14673When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14674protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14675By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14676"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14677will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14678logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14679
14680The format looks like this :
14681
14682 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14683 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14684 Connection error during SSL handshake
14685
14686 Field Format Extract from the example above
14687 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14688 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14689 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14690 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14691 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14692
14693These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14694failures.
14695
14696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146978.3. Advanced logging options
14698-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014699
14700Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14701just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14702options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14703for more information about their usage.
14704
14705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14707------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014708
14709It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14710haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14711commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14712monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14713ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14714
14715 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14716 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14717 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14718 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14719
14720 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14721 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14722 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014723 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014724 such as other load-balancers.
14725
14726 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14727 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14728 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14729
14730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147318.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14732----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014733
14734The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14735what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14736or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14737"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14738just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14739log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14740after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14741is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14742with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14743with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14744
14745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147468.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14747------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014748
14749Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14750for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14751"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14752retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14753raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14754a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14755file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14756you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14757"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14758
14759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147608.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14761--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014762
14763Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14764multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14765them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14766"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14767logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14768error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14769and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14770too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14771useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14772alternative.
14773
14774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147758.4. Timing events
14776------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014777
14778Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14779reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14780the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14781frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14782mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14783
14784 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14785 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14786 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14787 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14788 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14789
14790 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14791 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14792 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14793 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14794 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14795
14796 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14797 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14798 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14799 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14800 connection never established.
14801
14802 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14803 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14804 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14805 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14806 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14807 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14808 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14809 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14810 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14811 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14812 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14813
14814 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14815 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14816 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14817 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014818 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014819
14820 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14821
14822 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14823 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14824 negative.
14825
14826These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14827protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14828that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014829due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014830close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14831session has been aborted on timeout.
14832
14833Most common cases :
14834
14835 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14836 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14837 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14838 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14839 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14840 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14841 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14842 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14843 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010014844 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014845 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14846 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014847
14848 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14849 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14850 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14851 of ms on remote networks.
14852
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014853 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14854 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14855 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014856
14857 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14858 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14859 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14860 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14861 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14862 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14863 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14864 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14865 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14866 to the server until another one is released.
14867
14868Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14869
14870 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14871 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14872 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14873
14874 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14875 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14876 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14877
14878 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14879 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14880 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14881 flags.
14882
14883 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14884 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14885 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14886 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14887 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14888 the client connection was maintained open.
14889
14890 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014891 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014892 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14893 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14894
14895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148968.5. Session state at disconnection
14897-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014898
14899TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14900"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
149012-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14902each of which has a special meaning :
14903
14904 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14905 session to terminate :
14906
14907 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14908
14909 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14910 server explicitly refused it.
14911
14912 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14913 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14914 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14915 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014916 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14917
14918 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14919 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014920
14921 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14922 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14923 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14924 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14925 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14926
14927 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14928 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14929 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14930 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14931 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14932
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014933 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14934 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14935
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014936 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14937 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14938 backup connections when going up.
14939
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014940 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14941
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014942 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14943 send or receive data.
14944
14945 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14946 send or receive data.
14947
14948 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14949 with nothing left in the buffers.
14950
14951 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14952
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014953 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014954 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14955
14956 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14957 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14958 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14959 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14960 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14961
14962 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14963 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14964
14965 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14966 server (HTTP only).
14967
14968 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14969
14970 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14971 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14972 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14973
14974 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14975 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14976 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14977
14978 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14979
14980 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14981 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14982
14983 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14984 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14985 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14986
14987 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14988 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014989 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14990 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014991
14992 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14993 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14994 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14995 another server.
14996
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014997 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014998 server.
14999
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015000 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15001 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15002 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15003 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15004
15005 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15006 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15007 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15008 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15009
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015010 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15011 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15012 "use-server" rule).
15013
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015014 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15015
15016 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15017 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15018
15019 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15020
15021 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15022 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15023 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15024
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015025 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15026 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015027 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015028 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15029 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015031 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15032
15033 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15034 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15035
15036 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15037
15038 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15039
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015040The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15041was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015042helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15043starvation, attacks, etc...
15044
15045The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15046alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15047easier finding and understanding.
15048
15049 Flags Reason
15050
15051 -- Normal termination.
15052
15053 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15054 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15055 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15056 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15057
15058 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15059 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15060 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15061 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15062 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15063 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015065 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15066 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015067 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015068
15069 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15070 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15071 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15072
15073 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15074 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15075 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15076 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15077 the server takes too long to respond.
15078
15079 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15080 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15081 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15082 long a time to respond.
15083
15084 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15085 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15086 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15087 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015088 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15089 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015090
15091 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15092 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15093 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15094 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15095 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015096 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015097 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15098 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15099 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15100 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15101 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15102 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15103 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15104 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15105 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15106 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15107 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15108 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015109
15110 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15111 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015112 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15113 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15114 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15115 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015116
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015117 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15118 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015120 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015121 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15122 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15123 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15124 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15125 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15126
15127 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15128 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15129 503 or 504 here.
15130
15131 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15132 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15133 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15134 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15135 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15136
15137 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15138 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015139 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015140 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15141 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15142
15143 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15144 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15145 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15146 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15147 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15148 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15149 between haproxy and the server.
15150
15151 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15152 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15153 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15154 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15155 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15156 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15157 solution is to fix the application.
15158
15159 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15160 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15161 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15162 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15163 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15164 external attacks.
15165
15166 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15167 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015168 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015169 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15170 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15171
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015172 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15173 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15174 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015175 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15176 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015177
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015178 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15179 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15180 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15181 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015182 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15183 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15184 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15185 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15186 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015187
15188 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15189 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15190 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15191 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15192
15193 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15194 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15195 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15196 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15197
15198 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15199 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15200 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15201 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15202
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015203The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15204persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15205important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15206re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15207
15208 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15209
15210 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15211 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15212 set on a GET request.
15213
15214 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15215 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015216 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015217 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15218
15219 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15220 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15221 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15222
15223 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15224 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15225 already got a cookie.
15226
15227 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15228 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15229 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15230 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15231 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15232
15233 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15234 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15235 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15236
15237 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15238 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15239 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15240
15241 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15242 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15243
15244 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15245 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15246 then advertised in the response.
15247
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152498.6. Non-printable characters
15250-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015251
15252In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15253consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15254converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15255prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15256being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15257escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15258is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15259'}' when logging headers.
15260
15261Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15262issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15263containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15264
15265Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15266the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15267performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15268
15269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152708.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15271---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015272
15273Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15274achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015275section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015276cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15277the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15278the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015279locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015280not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15281user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15282a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15283wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15284
15285 Examples :
15286 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15287 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15288
15289 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15290 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15291
15292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152938.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15294---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015295
15296Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15297proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15298the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15299server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15300
15301Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15302response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015303section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015304
15305It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015306time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15307appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015308are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15309and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15310follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15311request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15312in the logs.
15313
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015314As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15315frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15316an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15317
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015318 Example :
15319 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15320 listen proxy-out
15321 mode http
15322 option httplog
15323 option logasap
15324 log global
15325 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15326
15327 # log the name of the virtual server
15328 capture request header Host len 20
15329
15330 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15331 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15332
15333 # log the beginning of the referrer
15334 capture request header Referer len 20
15335
15336 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15337 capture response header Server len 20
15338
15339 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15340 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15341
15342 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15343 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15344
15345 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15346 capture response header Via len 20
15347
15348 # log the URL location during a redirection
15349 capture response header Location len 20
15350
15351 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15352 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15353 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15354 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15355 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15356
15357 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15358 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15359 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15360 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015361 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015362
15363 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15364 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15365 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15366 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15367 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015368 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015369
15370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153718.9. Examples of logs
15372---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015373
15374These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15375them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15376reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15377
15378 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15379 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15380 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15381
15382 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15383 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15384
15385 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15386 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15387 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15388
15389 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15390 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15391
15392 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15393 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15394 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15395
15396 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015397 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015398 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15399 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15400
15401 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15402 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15403 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15404
15405 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15406 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015407 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015408 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15409 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15410 to return the 502 and not the server.
15411
15412 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015413 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015414
15415 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15416 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15417 Nothing was sent to any server.
15418
15419 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15420 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15421
15422 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15423 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15424 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15425 send a 408 return code to the client.
15426
15427 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15428 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15429
15430 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15431 5 seconds ("c----").
15432
15433 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15434 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015435 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015436
15437 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015438 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015439 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15440 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15441 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15442 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15443 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015444
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015446/*
15447 * Local variables:
15448 * fill-column: 79
15449 * End:
15450 */